Canon TR4530

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 454

TR4500 series

Online Manual

English
Contents
Using Online Manual. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
Symbols Used in This Document. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
Touch-enabled Device Users (Windows). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
Trademarks and Licenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

Basic Operation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
Printing Photos from a Computer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
Printing Photos from a Smartphone/Tablet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
Copying. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
Faxing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Restrictions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
Network Connection Tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
Default Network Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
Detect Same Printer Name. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Printing Network Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58

IJ Network Device Setup Utility (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59


IJ Network Device Setup Utility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
List of Models Which Does Not Support Diagnosis and Repair Function. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63

Handling Paper, Originals, FINE Cartridges, etc.. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64


Loading Paper. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 65
Loading Plain Paper. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
Loading Photo Paper. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
Loading Envelopes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

Loading Originals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
Where to Load Originals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
Loading Originals on Platen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
Loading Based on Use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
Supported Originals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91

Replacing a FINE Cartridge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93


Replacing a FINE Cartridge. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
Checking Ink Status on the LCD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
Ink Tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

If Printing Is Faint or Uneven. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102


Maintenance Procedure. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
Printing the Nozzle Check Pattern. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106
Examining the Nozzle Check Pattern. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
Cleaning the Print Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108
Deep Print Head Cleaning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
Aligning the Print Head. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

Performing Maintenance Functions from Your Computer (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113


Opening Remote UI for Maintenance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114
Cleaning the Print Heads. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115
Adjusting Print Head Position. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117
Checking Ink Status from Your Computer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118

Cleaning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119
Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120
Cleaning Inside the Printer (Bottom Plate Cleaning). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122

Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
Safety. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
Safety Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126
Regulatory Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129
WEEE (EU&EEA). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132

Handling Precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143


Legal Restrictions on Scanning/Copying. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
Transporting Your Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145
When Repairing, Lending, or Disposing of the Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
Keeping Print Quality High. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 148

Main Components and Their Use. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149


Main Components. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
Front View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
Rear View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 153
Inside View. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 154
Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 155

Power Supply. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 157

Checking that Power Is On. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158


Turning the Printer On and Off. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159
Checking the Power Plug/Power Cord. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161
Unplugging the Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162

LCD and Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163


Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 165

Changing Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 168


Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 169

Managing the Printer Power. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 170


Changing the Printer Operation Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 171

Changing Settings from Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172

Changing Settings from Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 173


Setting Items on Operation Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174
FAX settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 175
Print settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 180
LAN settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181
Other dev. settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Language selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186
Firmware update. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187
Reset setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188
Feed settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190
Web service setup. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
ECO settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
Quiet setting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194
System information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195

Specifications. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196

Information about Paper. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201


Supported Media Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Paper Load Limit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Unsupported Media Types. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
Handling Paper. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 207

Printing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 208
Printing from Computer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
Printing from Application Software (macOS AirPrint). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210

Printing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
Printing on Postcards. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214
Adding Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216
How to Open Printer Settings Screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 217
Displaying the Printing Status Screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 218
Deleting the Undesired Print Job. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219
Removing Printer That Is No Longer Required from List of Printers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 220

Printing Using Canon Application Software. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221


Printing Using a Web Service. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222

Printing from Smartphone/Tablet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223


Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 224

Paper Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228

Copying. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231
Making Copies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232
Setting Items for Copying. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 234

Scanning. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 237
Scanning from Computer (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Scanning According to Item Type or Purpose (IJ Scan Utility Lite). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239

IJ Scan Utility Lite Features. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240


Scanning Easily (Auto Scan). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 242
Scanning Documents and Photos. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 244

Scanning Tips. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 245

Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 246

Scanning Using Smartphone/Tablet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249

Faxing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 250
Preparing for Faxing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 251
Connecting Telephone Line. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 252
Setting Telephone Line Type. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 256
Setting Receive Mode. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
Setting Sender Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263

Registering Recipients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 268


Registering Recipients Using Operation Panel of Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269

Registering Fax/Telephone Number of Recipients. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 270


Registering Recipients in Group Dial. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 273
Changing Registered Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 276
Deleting Registered Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 278
Printing List of Registered Destinations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 279

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 280

Starting Up Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 281


Speed Dial Utility2 Dialog. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 282
Saving Registered Telephone Directory on Printer to Your Computer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 284
Registering a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 285
Changing a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 287
Deleting a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Changing Sender Information Using Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 290
Registering/Changing Rejected Number Using Speed Dial Utility2. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 291
Registering Telephone Directory Has been Saved on Your Computer to Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . 292

Sending Faxes Using Operation Panel of Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 293


Sending Faxes by Entering Fax/Telephone Number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 294
Resending Faxes (Redialing Busy Number). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 297
Setting Items for Sending Faxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 299

Sending Faxes from Computer (Mac OS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 301


Sending Faxes Using AirPrint. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 302
General Notes (Fax Transmission Using AirPrint). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 306

Receiving Faxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 307


Receiving Faxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 308
Changing Paper Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 313
Memory Reception. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 315

Other Useful Fax Functions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 317


Document Stored in Printer's Memory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 318
Printing Document in Printer's Memory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
Deleting Document in Printer's Memory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321

Frequently Asked Questions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323


Network Settings and Common Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 325
Network Communication Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 327
Cannot Find Printer on Network. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 328

Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Setup (Windows). . . . . . . . . . . . . 329

Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Power Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 330
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
PC Network Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's Wi-Fi Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 332
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Wi-Fi Environment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 333
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's IP Address. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 335
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Security Software Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 336
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Wireless Router Settings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337

Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338


Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 340

Network Connection Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 343

Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 344


Network Key (Password) Unknown. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or Changed Router Settings. . . . . . . . 351

Other Network Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 353

Checking Network Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 354


Restoring to Factory Defaults. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 357

Problems while Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 358


Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 359

Printing Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 363


Printer Does Not Print. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 364
Ink Does Not Come Out. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 366
Paper Does Not Feed Properly/"No Paper" Error. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 368
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 371

Printouts Are Blank/Blurry or Fuzzy/Inaccurate or Bleeding Colors/Streaks or Lines. . . . . . . . . . 373


Colors Are Unclear. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 377
Lines Are Misaligned/Distorted. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 379
Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is Scratched. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 380
Vertical Line Next to Image. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 384

Scanning Problems (macOS). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 385


Scanning Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 386

Scanner Does Not Work. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 387


Scanner Driver Does Not Start. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 388

Faxing Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 389


Problems Sending Faxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 390

Cannot Send a Fax. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 391


Errors Often Occur When Send a Fax. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 394

Problems Receiving Faxes. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 395

Cannot Receive a Fax, Cannot Print a Fax. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 396

Telephone Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 399

Cannot Dial. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 400


Telephone Disconnects During a Call. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 401

Poor Quality Fax Received. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 402

Mechanical Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 403


Printer Does Not Turn On. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 404
Printer Turns Off Unexpectedly or Repeatedly. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 405
USB Connection Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 407
Cannot Communicate with Printer via USB. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 408
Wrong Language Appears in LCD. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 409

Installation and Download Problems. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 410


Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 411
Updating MP Drivers in Network Environment (Windows). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 413

Errors and Messages. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 414


An Error Occurs. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 415
Message (Support Code) Appears. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 416
List of Support Code for Error. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 419
List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 421
1300. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 422
1303. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 424
1304. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 425
Paper Is Jammed inside Printer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 426

Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 429

1003. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 432
1200. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 433
1203. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 434
1250. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 435
1401. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 436
1430. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 437
1485. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 438
1682. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 439
1686. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 440
1688. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 441
168A. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 442
1890. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 443
2110. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 444
2900. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 446
2901. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 447
4103. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 448
5011. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 449
5012. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 450
5100. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 451
5200. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 452
5B02. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 453
6000. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 454
Using Online Manual

Operating Environment

Symbols Used in This Document

Touch-enabled Device Users (Windows)

Printing Online Manual

Trademarks and Licenses

Screenshots in This Manual

10
Symbols Used in This Document

Warning
Instructions that, if ignored, could result in death, serious personal injury, or property damage caused by
incorrect operation of the equipment. These must be observed for safe operation.

Caution
Instructions that, if ignored, could result in personal injury or property damage caused by incorrect
operation of the equipment. These must be observed for safe operation.

Important
Instructions including important information that must be observed to avoid damage and injury or
improper use of the product. Be sure to read these instructions.

Note
Instructions including notes for operation and additional explanations.

Basics

Instructions explaining basic operations of your product.

Note
• Icons may vary depending on your product.

11
Touch-enabled Device Users (Windows)

For touch actions, you need to replace "right-click" in this document with the action set on the operating
system. For example, if the action is set to "press and hold" on your operating system, replace "right-click"
with "press and hold."

12
Trademarks and Licenses

• Microsoft is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation.


• Windows is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other
countries.
• Windows Vista is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or other
countries.
• Internet Explorer is a trademark or registered trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the U.S. and/or
other countries.
• Mac, Mac OS, macOS, OS X, AirPort, App Store, AirPrint, the AirPrint logo, Safari, Bonjour, iPad,
iPhone and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
• IOS is a trademark or registered trademark of Cisco in the U.S. and other countries and is used under
license.
• Google Cloud Print, Google Chrome, Chrome OS, Chromebook, Android, Google Drive, Google Apps
and Google Analytics are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Google Inc. Google Play and
Google Play Logo are trademarks of Google LLC.
• Adobe, Acrobat, Flash, Photoshop, Photoshop Elements, Lightroom, Adobe RGB and Adobe RGB
(1998) are either registered trademarks or trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United
States and/or other countries.
• Bluetooth is a trademark of Bluetooth SIG, Inc., U.S.A. and licensed to Canon Inc.
• Autodesk and AutoCAD are registered trademarks or trademarks of Autodesk, Inc., and/or its
subsidiaries and/or affiliates in the USA and/or other countries.

Note
• The formal name of Windows Vista is Microsoft Windows Vista operating system.

Copyright (c) 2003-2015 Apple Inc. All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. Neither the name of Apple Inc. ("Apple") nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE AND ITS CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL APPLE OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

13
Apache License
Version 2.0, January 2004

http://www.apache.org/licenses/
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION

1. Definitions.
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions for use, reproduction, and distribution as defined by
Sections 1 through 9 of this document.

"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity authorized by the copyright owner that is granting
the License.

"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting entity and all other entities that control, are controlled
by, or are under common control with that entity. For the purposes of this definition, "control" means
(i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by
contract or otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty percent (50%) or more of the outstanding shares, or (iii)
beneficial ownership of such entity.

"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal Entity exercising permissions granted by this
License.

"Source" form shall mean the preferred form for making modifications, including but not limited to
software source code, documentation source, and configuration files.

"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from mechanical transformation or translation of a Source
form, including but not limited to compiled object code, generated documentation, and conversions to
other media types.

"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether in Source or Object form, made available under
the License, as indicated by a copyright notice that is included in or attached to the work (an example
is provided in the Appendix below).

"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether in Source or Object form, that is based on (or
derived from) the Work and for which the editorial revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other
modifications represent, as a whole, an original work of authorship. For the purposes of this License,
Derivative Works shall not include works that remain separable from, or merely link (or bind by name)
to the interfaces of, the Work and Derivative Works thereof.

"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship, including the original version of the Work and any
modifications or additions to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to
Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright owner or by an individual or Legal Entity
authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner. For the purposes of this definition, "submitted"
means any form of electronic, verbal, or written communication sent to the Licensor or its
representatives, including but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists, source code
control systems, and issue tracking systems that are managed by, or on behalf of, the Licensor for
the purpose of discussing and improving the Work, but excluding communication that is
conspicuously marked or otherwise designated in writing by the copyright owner as "Not a
Contribution."

"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution
has been received by Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work.

14
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor
hereby grants to You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable
copyright license to reproduce, prepare Derivative Works of, publicly display, publicly perform,
sublicense, and distribute the Work and such Derivative Works in Source or Object form.
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby
grants to You a perpetual, worldwide, non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable (except as
stated in this section) patent license to make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell, import, and
otherwise transfer the Work, where such license applies only to those patent claims licensable by
such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their Contribution(s) alone or by combination of
their Contribution(s) with the Work to which such Contribution(s) was submitted. If You institute patent
litigation against any entity (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in a lawsuit) alleging that the
Work or a Contribution incorporated within the Work constitutes direct or contributory patent
infringement, then any patent licenses granted to You under this License for that Work shall terminate
as of the date such litigation is filed.
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the Work or Derivative Works thereof in
any medium, with or without modifications, and in Source or Object form, provided that You meet the
following conditions:

1. You must give any other recipients of the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this License; and
2. You must cause any modified files to carry prominent notices stating that You changed the files;
and
3. You must retain, in the Source form of any Derivative Works that You distribute, all copyright,
patent, trademark, and attribution notices from the Source form of the Work, excluding those
notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works; and
4. If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file as part of its distribution, then any Derivative Works that
You distribute must include a readable copy of the attribution notices contained within such
NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any part of the Derivative Works, in at
least one of the following places: within a NOTICE text file distributed as part of the Derivative
Works; within the Source form or documentation, if provided along with the Derivative Works; or,
within a display generated by the Derivative Works, if and wherever such third-party notices
normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE file are for informational purposes only and do not
modify the License. You may add Your own attribution notices within Derivative Works that You
distribute, alongside or as an addendum to the NOTICE text from the Work, provided that such
additional attribution notices cannot be construed as modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to Your modifications and may provide additional or
different license terms and conditions for use, reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications,
or for any such Derivative Works as a whole, provided Your use, reproduction, and distribution of
the Work otherwise complies with the conditions stated in this License.

5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explicitly state otherwise, any Contribution intentionally
submitted for inclusion in the Work by You to the Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions of
this License, without any additional terms or conditions. Notwithstanding the above, nothing herein
shall supersede or modify the terms of any separate license agreement you may have executed with
Licensor regarding such Contributions.
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant permission to use the trade names, trademarks, service
marks, or product names of the Licensor, except as required for reasonable and customary use in
describing the origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the NOTICE file.

15
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by applicable law or agreed to in writing, Licensor provides
the Work (and each Contributor provides its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT
WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY KIND, either express or implied, including, without
limitation, any warranties or conditions of TITLE, NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You are solely responsible for determining the
appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and assume any risks associated with Your
exercise of permissions under this License.
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no legal theory, whether in tort (including negligence),
contract, or otherwise, unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly negligent
acts) or agreed to in writing, shall any Contributor be liable to You for damages, including any direct,
indirect, special, incidental, or consequential damages of any character arising as a result of this
License or out of the use or inability to use the Work (including but not limited to damages for loss of
goodwill, work stoppage, computer failure or malfunction, or any and all other commercial damages
or losses), even if such Contributor has been advised of the possibility of such damages.
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability. While redistributing the Work or Derivative Works thereof,
You may choose to offer, and charge a fee for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity, or other
liability obligations and/or rights consistent with this License. However, in accepting such obligations,
You may act only on Your own behalf and on Your sole responsibility, not on behalf of any other
Contributor, and only if You agree to indemnify, defend, and hold each Contributor harmless for any
liability incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason of your accepting any
such warranty or additional liability.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS

---- Part 1: CMU/UCD copyright notice: (BSD like) -----

Copyright 1989, 1991, 1992 by Carnegie Mellon University

Derivative Work - 1996, 1998-2000

Copyright 1996, 1998-2000 The Regents of the University of California

All Rights Reserved


Permission to use, copy, modify and distribute this software and its documentation for any purpose and
without fee is hereby granted, provided that the above copyright notice appears in all copies and that both
that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation, and that the name of
CMU and The Regents of the University of California not be used in advertising or publicity pertaining to
distribution of the software without specific written permission.

CMU AND THE REGENTS OF THE UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA DISCLAIM ALL WARRANTIES
WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS. IN NO EVENT SHALL CMU OR THE REGENTS OF THE
UNIVERSITY OF CALIFORNIA BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM THE LOSS OF USE, DATA OR
PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.

---- Part 2: Networks Associates Technology, Inc copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Networks Associates Technology, Inc

All rights reserved.

16
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of the Networks Associates Technology, Inc nor the names of its contributors may be
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 3: Cambridge Broadband Ltd. copyright notice (BSD) -----

Portions of this code are copyright (c) 2001-2003, Cambridge Broadband Ltd.

All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* The name of Cambridge Broadband Ltd. may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 4: Sun Microsystems, Inc. copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright c 2003 Sun Microsystems, Inc., 4150 Network Circle, Santa Clara, California 95054, U.S.A. All
rights reserved.

17
Use is subject to license terms below.
This distribution may include materials developed by third parties.

Sun, Sun Microsystems, the Sun logo and Solaris are trademarks or registered trademarks of Sun
Microsystems, Inc. in the U.S. and other countries.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of the Sun Microsystems, Inc. nor the names of its contributors may be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 5: Sparta, Inc copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright (c) 2003-2012, Sparta, Inc

All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of Sparta, Inc nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR

18
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 6: Cisco/BUPTNIC copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright (c) 2004, Cisco, Inc and Information Network Center of Beijing University of Posts and
Telecommunications.

All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of Cisco, Inc, Beijing University of Posts and Telecommunications, nor the names of
their contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific
prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS''
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 7: Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG copyright notice (BSD) -----
Copyright (c) Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG, 2003 [email protected]

Author: Bernhard Penz <[email protected]>

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* The name of Fabasoft R&D Software GmbH & Co KG or any of its subsidiaries, brand or product names
may not be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software without specific prior written
permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,

19
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR
BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 8: Apple Inc. copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright (c) 2007 Apple Inc. All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. Neither the name of Apple Inc. ("Apple") nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY APPLE AND ITS CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL APPLE OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR
PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF
THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

---- Part 9: ScienceLogic, LLC copyright notice (BSD) -----

Copyright (c) 2009, ScienceLogic, LLC

All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of ScienceLogic, LLC nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or
promote products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE

20
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

LEADTOOLS

Copyright (C) 1991-2009 LEAD Technologies, Inc.

CMap Resources

-----------------------------------------------------------
Copyright 1990-2009 Adobe Systems Incorporated.
All rights reserved.

Copyright 1990-2010 Adobe Systems Incorporated.


All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or


without modification, are permitted provided that the
following conditions are met:

Redistributions of source code must retain the above


copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer.

Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above


copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials
provided with the distribution.

Neither the name of Adobe Systems Incorporated nor the names


of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior
written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND


CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES,
INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR
CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR
OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS
SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

-----------------------------------------------------------

21
MIT License
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source Software Center Ltd

Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following
conditions:

The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS OR
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN
CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.

Copyright 2000 Computing Research Labs, New Mexico State University

Copyright 2001-2015 Francesco Zappa Nardelli

Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell copies
of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject to the following
conditions:

The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.

THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COMPUTING
RESEARCH LAB OR NEW MEXICO STATE UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN
THE SOFTWARE.

Written by Joel Sherrill <[email protected]>.

COPYRIGHT (c) 1989-2000.

On-Line Applications Research Corporation (OAR).

Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software for any purpose without fee is hereby
granted, provided that this entire notice is included in all copies of any software which is or includes a
copy or modification of this software.

THIS SOFTWARE IS BEING PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTY.
IN PARTICULAR, THE AUTHOR MAKES NO REPRESENTATION OR WARRANTY OF ANY KIND

22
CONCERNING THE MERCHANTABILITY OF THIS SOFTWARE OR ITS FITNESS FOR ANY
PARTICULAR PURPOSE.

(1) Red Hat Incorporated

Copyright (c) 1994-2009 Red Hat, Inc. All rights reserved.

This copyrighted material is made available to anyone wishing to use, modify, copy, or redistribute it
subject to the terms and conditions of the BSD License. This program is distributed in the hope that it will
be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY expressed or implied, including the implied warranties of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. A copy of this license is available at
http://www.opensource.org/licenses. Any Red Hat trademarks that are incorporated in the source code or
documentation are not subject to the BSD License and may only be used or replicated with the express
permission of Red Hat, Inc.

(2) University of California, Berkeley


Copyright (c) 1981-2000 The Regents of the University of California.

All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the
following disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.

THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS" AND
ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE,
EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

The FreeType Project LICENSE

----------------------------

2006-Jan-27

Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by

David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg

Introduction

============

23
The FreeType Project is distributed in several archive packages; some of them may contain, in addition to
the FreeType font engine, various tools and contributions which rely on, or relate to, the FreeType Project.

This license applies to all files found in such packages, and which do not fall under their own explicit
license. The license affects thus the FreeType font engine, the test programs, documentation and
makefiles, at the very least.

This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and IJG (Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which all
encourage inclusion and use of free software in commercial and freeware products alike. As a
consequence, its main points are that:

o We don't promise that this software works. However, we will be interested in any kind of bug reports.
(`as is' distribution)

o You can use this software for whatever you want, in parts or full form, without having to pay us.
(`royalty-free' usage)
o You may not pretend that you wrote this software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in a program, you
must acknowledge somewhere in your documentation that you have used the FreeType code. (`credits')

We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion of this software, with or without modifications, in
commercial products.

We disclaim all warranties covering The FreeType Project and assume no liability related to The
FreeType Project.

Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form for a credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with this
license. We thus encourage you to use the following text:

"""

Portions of this software are copyright © <year> The FreeType

Project (www.freetype.org). All rights reserved.

"""

Please replace <year> with the value from the FreeType version you actually use.
Legal Terms

===========

0. Definitions

--------------

Throughout this license, the terms `package', `FreeType Project', and `FreeType archive' refer to the set
of files originally distributed by the authors (David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg) as the
`FreeType Project', be they named as alpha, beta or final release.

`You' refers to the licensee, or person using the project, where `using' is a generic term including
compiling the project's source code as well as linking it to form a `program' or `executable'.

This program is referred to as `a program using the FreeType engine'.

This license applies to all files distributed in the original FreeType Project, including all source code,
binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its original, unmodified form as
distributed in the original archive.

If you are unsure whether or not a particular file is covered by this license, you must contact us to verify
this.

24
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg.
All rights reserved except as specified below.

1. No Warranty

--------------

THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED `AS IS' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF THE AUTHORS OR
COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE USE OR THE INABILITY
TO USE, OF THE FREETYPE PROJECT.

2. Redistribution

-----------------
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free, perpetual and irrevocable right and license to use, execute,
perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of, distribute and sublicense the FreeType Project
(in both source and object code forms) and derivative works thereof for any purpose; and to authorize
others to exercise some or all of the rights granted herein, subject to the following conditions:

o Redistribution of source code must retain this license file (`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any additions, deletions
or changes to the original files must be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation. The copyright
notices of the unaltered, original files must be preserved in all copies of source files.

o Redistribution in binary form must provide a disclaimer that states that the software is based in part of
the work of the FreeType Team, in the distribution documentation. We also encourage you to put an URL
to the FreeType web page in your documentation, though this isn't mandatory.

These conditions apply to any software derived from or based on the FreeType Project, not just the
unmodified files. If you use our work, you must acknowledge us. However, no fee need be paid to us.

3. Advertising

--------------

Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor you shall use the name of the other for commercial,
advertising, or promotional purposes without specific prior written permission.

We suggest, but do not require, that you use one or more of the following phrases to refer to this software
in your documentation or advertising materials: `FreeType Project', `FreeType Engine', `FreeType library',
or `FreeType Distribution'.

As you have not signed this license, you are not required to accept it. However, as the FreeType Project
is copyrighted material, only this license, or another one contracted with the authors, grants you the right
to use, distribute, and modify it.

Therefore, by using, distributing, or modifying the FreeType Project, you indicate that you understand and
accept all the terms of this license.

4. Contacts

-----------

There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:

o [email protected]

25
Discusses general use and applications of FreeType, as well as future and wanted additions to the library
and distribution.

If you are looking for support, start in this list if you haven't found anything to help you in the
documentation.

o [email protected]

Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.

Our home page can be found at

http://www.freetype.org

--- end of FTL.TXT ---

The TWAIN Toolkit is distributed as is. The developer and distributors of the TWAIN Toolkit expressly
disclaim all implied, express or statutory warranties including, without limitation, the implied warranties of
merchantability, noninfringement of third party rights and fitness for a particular purpose. Neither the
developers nor the distributors will be liable for damages, whether direct, indirect, special, incidental, or
consequential, as a result of the reproduction, modification, distribution or other use of the TWAIN Toolkit.

The following applies only to products supporting Wi-Fi.

(c) 2009-2013 by Jeff Mott. All rights reserved.

Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without modification, are permitted provided
that the following conditions are met:

* Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice, this list of conditions, and the
following disclaimer.
* Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of conditions, and the
following disclaimer in the documentation or other materials provided with the distribution.
* Neither the name CryptoJS nor the names of its contributors may be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS IS,"
AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ARE
DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.

26
Basic Operation

Printing Photos from a Computer

Printing Photos from a Smartphone/Tablet

Copying

Faxing

27
Printing Photos from a Computer

This section describes how to print photos with Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.

1. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.

3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

4. Load photo paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.

28
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed
on the LCD.

29
7. Press the OK button.

8. Use the button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

9. Use the button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.

11. Open the output tray extension (E).

30
12. Start Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.

For Windows:
The procedure below is for a computer running the Windows 10 operating system.

From the Start menu, select (All apps >) Canon Utilities > Easy-PhotoPrint Editor.

For macOS:
From the Go menu in Finder, select Application and double-click the Canon Utilities folder, the Easy-
PhotoPrint Editor folder, and then the Easy-PhotoPrint Editor icon.

13. Click Photos icon (F).

14. Click Browse (G) in From computer: and select folder with photos you want to print.

15. Click photos (H) you want to print and select Open (I).

For Windows:

To select two or more photos at a time, click photos while pressing the Ctrl key.

For macOS:

To select two or more photos at a time, click photos while pressing the command key.

31
16. Specify number of copies and other options under Print Settings (J).

For Windows:
Specify the number of copies, your model name, the paper size, and other options.

For macOS:

Specify the number of copies, the paper size, and other options.

Note
• Selecting Same No. of each photo enables you to specify the number of copies for all photos
with a single setting.

• Selecting Same No. of each photo disables the number-of-copies setting specified for each

photo. When unchecked, the previous settings for each copy are re-enabled. for specifying
the number of copies is also re-enabled.

17. Start printing.

For Windows:

Click Print (K).

For macOS:

Click Next. When the Print dialog appears, specify your model name, paper, and other options, and then
click Print.

32
Note
• Easy-PhotoPrint Editor lets you easily create and print original collages, cards, or calendars using your
favorite photos.

Easy-PhotoPrint Editor Guide

33
Printing Photos from a Smartphone/Tablet

This section describes how to print photos with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.

For details on how to download Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY, see below.

Print Easily from a Smartphone or Tablet with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY

1. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.

3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

4. Load photo paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.

34
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed
on the LCD.

35
7. Press the OK button.

8. Use the button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

9. Use the button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.

11. Open the output tray extension (E).

36
12. Start (Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY) from your smartphone/tablet.

13. Select Photo Print on Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.


The list of photos saved on your smartphone/tablet is displayed.

14. Select a photo.


You can also select multiple photos at once.

15. Specify the number of copies, paper size, etc.

16. Select Print.

37
Copying

This section describes how to load originals and copy them to plain paper loaded.

1. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

2. Pull out the cassette until it stops.

3. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

4. Load plain paper in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.

38
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

5. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

6. Push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen for the cassette is displayed
on the LCD.

39
7. Press the OK button.

8. Use the button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

9. Use the button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

10. Pull the paper output support (D) out from the paper output tray.

11. Open the output tray extension (E).

40
12. Press the COPY button (F).

13. Open the document cover (G).

14. Load the original WITH THE SIDE TO COPY FACING DOWN and align it with the
alignment mark (H).

Note
• To copy two or more documents continuously, load them in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

41
Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

15. Close the document cover gently.

16. Confirm the paper settings, then press the Black button (I) or Color button (J).

Important
• Do not open the document cover until copying is complete.

Note
• Your printer is equipped with many other convenient copy features.

Copying

42
Faxing

Fax multiple documents in black and white as follows.

1. Open the document tray (A).

2. Slide the document guide (B) all the way out.

3. Insert the document WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING UP.

4. Align document guide (B) with document width.

43
5. Press the FAX button (C).

6. Use the Numeric buttons (D) to enter the fax number.

7. Press the Black button (E).

Note
• Many other convenient faxing features are available.

Faxing

44
Network

Available Connection Methods


The following connection methods are available on the printer.

• Wireless Connection
Connect the printer and devices (e.g. computer/smartphone/tablet) using a wireless router.

If you have a wireless router, we recommend you use one for wireless connection.

◦ Connection methods vary depending on the wireless router type.


◦ You can change network settings such as the network name (SSID) and security protocol on the
printer.
◦ When the connection between a device and a wireless router is completed and (Wi-Fi icon) is
displayed in the device's screen, you can connect the device to the printer using the wireless router.

• Wireless Direct
Connect the printer and devices (e.g. computer/smartphone/tablet) without using a wireless router.

◦ While you are using the printer with Wireless Direct, Internet connection from the printer becomes
unavailable. In that case, web services for the printer cannot be used.
◦ If you connect a device connected to the Internet via a wireless router to the printer that is in the
Wireless Direct, the connection between the device and wireless router will be disabled. In that case,
the connection of the device may switch to a mobile data connection automatically depending on
your device. Transmission fees for connecting to the Internet using a mobile data connection apply.
◦ In the Wireless Direct, you can connect up to five devices at the same time. If you try to connect a
sixth device while five devices are already connected, an error will appear. If an error appears,
disconnect a device you do not use and configure settings again.
◦ Network settings such as the network name (SSID) and security protocol are specified automatically.

Note
• You can connect the printer and computer using a USB cable (USB connection). Prepare a USB
cable. For details, see Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN
Connection.

Network Connection Settings/Setup


Perform connection setup for the printer and computer/smartphone/tablet.

For more on setup procedure, click here.

45
Changing Network Settings
See below for changing connection settings for the printer and computer/smartphone/tablet.

• To change network connection method:


Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection

Changing the Connection Mode

• To add computer/smartphone/tablet to the printer:


Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN Connection

• To use Wireless Direct temporarily:


Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct

IJ Network Device Setup Utility


IJ Network Device Setup Utility checks or diagnoses the settings of the printer and those of computer and
restores the status of them if anything is wrong with network connection. Select either link below to download
IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• Performing/Changing Network Settings (Windows)

For Windows, you can perform network settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

IJ Network Device Setup Utility (Windows)


• Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings (Windows/macOS)

You can diagnose or repair network settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility.
◦ For Windows:

IJ Network Device Setup Utility (Windows)


◦ For macOS:

IJ Network Device Setup Utility (macOS)

Network Connection Tips


See below for tips on using the printer via network connection.

Network Connection Tips


Handling Printer Configuration using the Web Browser

Troubleshooting
See Network Settings and Common Problems for troubleshooting on network connection.

Notice/Restriction
See below for details.

• Restrictions on network settings:


Restrictions

• Notices when printing using web service:


Notice for Web Service Printing

46
Restrictions

When connecting another device while a device (such as a computer) is already connected to the printer,
connect it using the same connection method as the connected device.
If you connect using a different connection method, the connection to the device in use will be disabled.

Connect via wireless router


• Make sure your device and the wireless router are connected. For details on checking these settings,
see the manual supplied with the wireless router or contact its manufacturer.
As for a device already connected to the printer without using a wireless router, reconnect it via a
wireless router.
• Configuration, router functions, setup procedures and security settings of wireless routers vary
depending on the system environment. For details, see the manual for your wireless router or contact
its manufacturer.
• This printer does not support IEEE802.11ac. IEEE802.11a and IEEE802.11n (5 GHz) may not be
supported depending on the country or region you live in. Check if your device supports IEEE802.11n,
IEEE802.11g, IEEE802.11b or IEEE802.11a.
• If your device is set to the "IEEE802.11n only" mode, WEP or TKIP cannot be used as a security
protocol. Change the security protocol for your device to something other than WEP and TKIP or
change the setting to something other than "IEEE802.11n only."
The connection between your device and the wireless router will be temporarily disabled while the
setting is changed. Do not proceed to the next screen of this guide until setup is complete.
• For office use, consult your network administrator.
• Note that if you connect to a network with no security protection, your personal information could be
disclosed to a third party.

Wireless Direct
Important
• If a device is connected to the Internet via a wireless router, and you then connect it to a printer in
Wireless Direct mode, the existing connection between the device and wireless router will be
disabled. In that case, the connection of the device may switch to a mobile data connection
automatically depending on your device. When you connect to the Internet using a mobile data
connection, charges may apply depending on your contract.

• When you connect a device and the printer using Wireless Direct, the connection information will
be saved to Wi-Fi settings. The device may be connected to the printer automatically even after
disconnecting it or connecting it to another wireless router.
• To prevent automatic connection to the printer in Wireless Direct mode, change the connection
mode after using the printer, or set not to connect automatically in the Wi-Fi settings of the
device.
For details on checking or changing the wireless router settings, see the wireless router manual
or contact its manufacturer.

• If you connect a device and the printer using Wireless Direct, Internet connection may become
unavailable depending on your environment. In that case, web services for the printer cannot be used.

47
• In Wireless Direct mode, you can connect up to five devices at the same time. If you try to connect a
sixth device while five devices are already connected, an error will appear.
If an error appears, disconnect a device that does not use the printer, then configure settings again.
• Devices connected to the printer using Wireless Direct cannot communicate with each other.
• Firmware updates for the printer are not available while using Wireless Direct.
• When a device has been connected to the printer without using a wireless router and you want to set
it up again using the same connection method, disconnect it first. Disable the connection between the
device and printer in the Wi-Fi setting screen.

48
Network Connection Tips

Default Network Settings

Detect Same Printer Name

Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN Connection

Printing Network Settings

Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection

49
Default Network Settings

LAN Connection Defaults


Item Default

Enable/Disable LAN Disable LAN

SSID BJNPSETUP

Wi-Fi security Disable

IP address (IPv4) Auto setup

IP address (IPv6) Auto setup

Set printer name* XXXXXXXXXXXX

Enable/disable IPv6 Enable

Enable/disable WSD Enable

Timeout setting 15 minutes

Enab./disab. Bonjour Enable

Service name Canon TR4500 series

LPR setting Active

RAW protocol Active

LLMNR Active

("XX" represents alphanumeric characters.)

* Default value depends on printer. To check value, use operation panel.

LAN settings

Wireless Direct Defaults


Item Default

Network name (SSID) for wireless direct DIRECT-abXX-TR4500series *1

WL Direct dev. name DIRECT-abXX-TR4500series *1

Password YYYYYYYYYY *2

Security method WPA2-PSK (AES)

Confirm request Displayed

50
*1 "ab" is specified at random and "XX" represents last two digits of printer's MAC address. (The value is
specified when the printer is turned on for the first time.)

*2 The password is specified automatically when the printer is turned on for the first time.

51
Detect Same Printer Name

When the printer is detected during setup, plural printers with the same name may appear on the results
screen.

Select a printer with checking the printer settings against those on detection result screen.

• For Windows:
Check the printer's MAC address or serial to select the correct printer from the results.

• For macOS:

The printer names appear with the MAC address added at the end or as the printer name specified by
Bonjour.
Check identifiers such as the MAC address, the printer name specified by Bonjour, and the printer's
serial number to select the printer from among those that appear.

Note
• Serial number may not appear on result screen.

To check the printer's MAC address and the serial number, print out the network settings information.

Printing Network Settings

Note
• You can check the serial number by displaying on the LCD.

System information

52
Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to
LAN Connection

For Windows:
For macOS:

For Windows:
To add a computer to connect to the printer on a LAN or to change from USB to LAN connection, perform
setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

For macOS:
To connect an additional computer to the printer via LAN, or to change from USB to LAN connection,
perform setup from the web page.

53
Printing Network Settings

Use the operation panel to print the printer's current network settings.

Important
• The network settings printout contains important information about your network. Handle it with care.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load two sheets of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper.

3. Press Setup button.


The Setup menu screen appears.

4. Select Device settings and press OK button.

5. Select LAN settings and press OK button.

6. Select Print LAN details and press OK button.


The printer starts printing the network setting information.

The following information on the printer's network setting is printed out. (Some setting values are not
displayed depending on the printer settings.)

Item Num- Item Description Setting


ber

1 Product Information Product information –

1-1 Product Name Product name XXXXXXXX

1-2 ROM Version ROM version XXXXXXXX

1-3 Serial Number Serial number XXXXXXXX

2 Network Diagnostics Network diagnostics ―

2-1 Diagnostic Result Diagnostic result XXXXXXXX

2-2 Result Codes Result codes XXXXXXXX

2-3 Result Code Details Result code details http://canon.com/ijnwt

3 Wireless LAN Wireless LAN Enable/Disable

3-2 Infrastructure Infrastructure Enable/Disable

3-2-1 Signal Strength Signal strength 0 to 100 [%]

3-2-2 Link Quality Link quality 0 to 100 [%]

54
3-2-3 Frequency Frequency XX (GHz)

3-2-4 MAC Address MAC address XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX

3-2-5 Connection Connection status Active/Inactive

3-2-6 SSID SSID Wireless LAN network name (SSID)

3-2-7 Channel Channel XX (1 to 13)

3-2-8 Encryption Encryption method None/WEP/TKIP/AES

3-2-9 WEP Key Length WEP key length (bits) Inactive/128/64

3-2-10 Authentication Authentication method None/auto/open/shared/WPA-PSK/WPA2-PSK

3-2-11 TCP/IPv4 TCP/IPv4 Enable

3-2-12 IP Address IP address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-2-13 Subnet Mask Subnet mask XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-2-14 Default Gateway Default gateway XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-2-15 TCP/IPv6 TCP/IPv6 Enable/Disable

3-2-16 Link Local Address Link local address XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-17 Link Local Prefix Link local prefix length XXX


Length

3-2-18 Stateless Address1 Stateless address 1 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-19 Stateless Prefix Stateless prefix length XXX


Length1 1

3-2-20 Stateless Address2 Stateless address 2 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-21 Stateless Prefix Stateless prefix length XXX


Length2 2

3-2-22 Stateless Address3 Stateless address 3 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-23 Stateless Prefix Stateless prefix length XXX


Length3 3

3-2-24 Stateless Address4 Stateless address 4 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-25 Stateless Prefix Stateless prefix length XXX


Length4 4

55
3-2-26 Default Gateway1 Default gateway 1 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-27 Default Gateway2 Default gateway 2 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-28 Default Gateway3 Default gateway 3 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-29 Default Gateway4 Default gateway 4 XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-2-33 IPsec IPsec setting Active

3-2-34 Security Protocol Security method ESP/ESP & AH/AH

3-3 Wireless Direct Operation mode for Enable/Disable


Wireless Direct

3-3-1 MAC Address MAC address XX:XX:XX:XX:XX:XX

3-3-2 Connection Connection status Active/Inactive

3-3-3 SSID SSID Wireless Direct network name (SSID)

3-3-4 Password Password Wireless Direct password (10 alphanumeric characters)

3-3-5 Channel Channel 3

3-3-6 Encryption Encryption method AES

3-3-7 Authentication Authentication method WPA2-PSK

3-3-8 TCP/IPv4 TCP/IPv4 Enable

3-3-9 IP Address IP address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-3-10 Subnet Mask Subnet mask XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-3-11 Default Gateway Default gateway XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

3-3-12 TCP/IPv6 TCP/IPv6 Enable/Disable

3-3-13 Link Local Address Link local address XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

XXXX:XXXX:XXXX:XXXX

3-3-14 Link Local Prefix Link local prefix length XXX


Length

3-3-15 IPsec IPsec setting Active

3-3-16 Security Protocol Security method –

5 Other Settings Other settings –

56
5-1 Printer Name Printer name Printer name (Up to 15 alphanumeric characters)

5-2 Wireless Direct Dev- Device name for wire- Device name for wireless direct (Up to 32 alphanumeric
Name less direct characters)

5-4 WSD Printing WSD printing setting Enable/Disable

5-5 WSD Timeout Timeout 1/5/10/15/20 [min]

5-6 LPD Printing LPD printing setting Enable/Disable

5-7 RAW Printing RAW printing setting Enable/Disable

5-9 Bonjour Bonjour setting Enable/Disable

5-10 Bonjour Service Name Bonjour service name Bonjour service name (Up to 52 alphanumeric characters)

5-11 LLMNR LLMNR setting Enable/Disable

5-12 SNMP SNMP setting Enable/Disable

5-14 DNS Server Obtain DNS server ad- Auto/Manual


dress automatically

5-15 Primary Server Primary server address XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

5-16 Secondary Server Secondary server ad- XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX


dress

5-17 Proxy Server Proxy server setting Enable/Disable

5-18 Proxy Address Proxy address XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX

5-19 Proxy Port Proxy port specification 1 to 65535

5-20 Cert. Fingerprt(SHA-1) Certificate finger- xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx


print(SHA-1) xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx

5-21 Cert. Fin- Certificate finger- xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx


gerprt(SHA-256) print(SHA-256) xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx xxxxxxxx

("XX" represents alphanumeric characters.)

57
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection

Follow either procedure below to change Wi-Fi connection method (infrastructure or Wireless Direct).

• For Windows:

◦ Redo setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.
◦ Perform settings on the Network Settings screen on IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

Important
• Before you perform settings using IJ Network Device Setup Utility, turn on Easy wireless
connect mode on the printer following the procedure below.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press Setup button.


The Setup menu screen appears.

3. Select Wi-Fi setup and press OK button.

4. Select Easy Wi-Fi connect and press OK button.


Follow instructions on your smartphone or tablet.

5. If message saying setup is completed appears, press OK button.

• For macOS:

Redo setup from the web page.

58
IJ Network Device Setup Utility (macOS)

IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings

List of Models Which Does Not Support Diagnosis and Repair Function

59
IJ Network Device Setup Utility

If anything is wrong with connection, IJ Network Device Setup Utility diagnoses the settings of the printer
and those of computer on which it is installed. In addition, IJ Network Device Setup Utility restores the status
of the printer and computer.

Important
• To use the printer over LAN, make sure you have the equipment necessary for the connection type,
such as a wireless router or a LAN cable.
• When you install IJ Network Device Setup Utility, disable block function of firewall.

60
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Start up Launchpad, select Canon Utilities, and then select IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

When you start up IJ Network Device Setup Utility, the screen below appears.

Enter the password specified for your computer and select Install Helper. IJ Network Device Setup Utility
starts diagnosis and repair of network.

Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings

61
Diagnosing and Repairing Network Settings

IJ Network Device Setup Utility diagnoses and repairs computer settings or connection between the
computer and printer when a problem (e.g. cannot print from a printer on the network) occurs.

Important
• Some models do not support diagnosis and repair function.
For details:

List of Models Which Does Not Support Diagnosis and Repair Function

IJ Network Device Setup Utility starts checking the computer settings when it starts up. Perform operations
following the instructions on the screen.

Note
• This function checks the following items:
• whether the computer is connected to the router
• whether the printer can be detected on the network
• whether the signal strength or communication level is sufficient (when using Wi-Fi)
• whether the printer port setting matches with the network setting

62
List of Models Which Does Not Support Diagnosis and Repair
Function

The following models does not support "Diagnose and Repair" function of IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• G4000 series
• PRO-500 series
• PRO-1000 series
• MB2100 series
• MB2700 series
• MB5100 series
• MB5400 series
• iB4000 series
• PRO-520
• PRO-540
• PRO-560
• PRO-540S
• PRO-560S
• PRO-2000
• PRO-4000
• PRO-6000
• PRO-4000S
• PRO-6000S
• TS9000 series
• TS8000 series
• TS6000 series
• TS5000 series
• MG3000 series
• E470 series

63
Handling Paper, Originals, FINE Cartridges, etc.

Loading Paper

Loading Originals

Replacing a FINE Cartridge

64
Loading Paper

Loading Plain Paper

Loading Photo Paper

Loading Envelopes

65
Loading Plain Paper

You can load plain paper.

Important
• If you cut plain paper to a size of 5" x 7" (13 x 18 cm) or smaller to perform a trial print, it may cause a
paper jam.

Note
• You can use general copy paper or Canon Red Label Superior WOP111/Canon Océ Office Colour
Paper SAT213.

For the page size and paper weight you can use for this printer, see Supported Media Types.

1. Prepare paper.
Align the edges of paper. If paper is curled, flatten it.

Note
• Align the edges of paper neatly before loading. Loading paper without aligning the edges may
cause paper jams.

• If paper is curled, hold the curled corners and gently bend them in the opposite direction until the
paper becomes completely flat.

For details on how to flatten curled paper, see Check3 in Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is
Scratched.

2. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

66
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.

4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

5. Load paper stack in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN, and place it in
center of cassette.
Push the paper stack all the way to the back of the cassette.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

Important
• Always load paper in portrait orientation (D). Loading paper in landscape orientation (E) can
cause paper jams.

67
6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the paper. The paper may not be fed properly.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

Note
• Do not load sheets of paper higher than the load limit mark (F).

• Keep the paper stack height below the tabs (G) of the paper guides.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front
cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back properly, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD.

68
8. Press the OK button.

9. Use the button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

10. Use the button to select Plain paper and press the OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

11. Pull the paper output support (H) out from the paper output tray.

12. Open the output tray extension (I).

69
Note
• There are various types of paper, such as paper with a special surface coating for printing photos at
optimal quality and paper suitable for documents. Each media type has specific preset settings (how ink
is used and sprayed, distance from nozzles, etc.), that allow you to print to that type with optimal image
quality. The wrong paper settings may cause poor printout color quality or scratches on the printed
surface. If you notice blurring or uneven colors, increase the print quality setting and try printing again.

• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper
settings.

70
Loading Photo Paper

You can load photo paper.

Important
• If you cut plain paper to a size of 5" x 7" (13 x 18 cm) or smaller to perform a trial print, it may cause a
paper jam.

Note
• We recommend Canon genuine photo paper for printing photos.

For details on the Canon genuine paper, see Supported Media Types.

1. Prepare paper.
Align the edges of paper. If paper is curled, flatten it.

Note
• Align the edges of paper neatly before loading. Loading paper without aligning the edges may
cause paper jams.

• If paper is curled, hold the curled corners and gently bend them in the opposite direction until the
paper becomes completely flat.

For details on how to flatten curled paper, see Check3 in Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is
Scratched.

• When using Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss SG-201, even if the sheet is curled, load one sheet at a
time as it is. If you roll up this paper to flatten, this may cause cracks on the surface of the paper
and reduce the print quality.

2. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

71
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.

4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

5. Load paper stack in portrait orientation WITH PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN, and place it in
center of cassette.
Push the paper stack all the way to the back of the cassette.

72
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

Important
• Always load paper in portrait orientation (D). Loading paper in landscape orientation (E) can
cause paper jams.

6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align the paper guides with both sides of the paper stack.
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the paper. The paper may not be fed properly.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

Note
• Do not load sheets of paper higher than the load limit mark (F).

• Keep the paper stack height below the tabs (G) of the paper guides.

73
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.
• Load small size paper, such as 4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm), by pushing it in all the way to the back of the
cassette.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front
cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back properly, the printer makes an electronic sound and the paper
information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.

74
8. Press the OK button.

9. Use the button to select the size of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

10. Use the button to select the type of the loaded paper in the cassette, then press the
OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

11. Pull the paper output support (H) out from the paper output tray.

12. Open the output tray extension (I).

75
Note
• There are various types of paper, such as paper with a special surface coating for printing photos at
optimal quality and paper suitable for documents. Each media type has specific preset settings (how ink
is used and sprayed, distance from nozzles, etc.), that allow you to print to that type with optimal image
quality. The wrong paper settings may cause poor printout color quality or scratches on the printed
surface. If you notice blurring or uneven colors, increase the print quality setting and try printing again.

• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper
settings.

76
Loading Envelopes

The address is automatically rotated and printed according to the envelope's direction by specifying with
your computer properly.

Important
• Printing of envelopes from the operation panel is not supported.

• Do not use the following envelopes. They could jam in the printer or cause the printer to malfunction.

• Envelopes with an embossed or treated surface

• Envelopes with a double flap

• Envelopes whose gummed flaps are already moistened and adhesive

1. Prepare envelopes.
• Press down on all four corners and edges of the envelopes to flatten them.

• If the envelopes are curled, hold the opposite corners and gently twist them in the opposite
direction.

• If the corner of the envelope flap is folded, flatten it.

• Use a pen to press the leading edge in the inserting direction flat and sharpen the crease.

The figures above show a side view of the leading edge of the envelope.

Important
• The envelopes may jam in the printer if they are not flat or the edges are not aligned. Make sure
that no curl or puff exceeds 0.12 inch (3 mm).

2. Open the front cover (A) gently.


The paper output tray (B) opens.

77
3. Grab handle part of front cover and pull out cassette until it stops.

4. Use the right paper guide (C) to slide both paper guides all the way out.

5. Load the envelopes in the center of the cassette WITH THE PRINT SIDE FACING DOWN.
Fold flap of the envelope and load the envelope in portrait orientation with the address side facing down.

Push the envelopes all the way to the back of the cassette. Up to 5 envelopes can be loaded at once.

78
* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

6. Slide the right paper guide (C) to align both paper guides with both sides of the envelopes.
Do not slide the paper guides too hard against the envelopes. The envelopes may not be fed properly.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

Note
• Do not load envelopes higher than the load limit mark (D).

• Keep the envelope stack height below the tabs (E) of the paper guides.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.

7. Grab right and left sides of front cover and push cassette back until arrow ( ) on front
cover is aligned with edge of printer.
After pushing the cassette back properly, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD.

79
8. Press the OK button.

9. Use button to select size of loaded envelopes in cassette and press OK button.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

10. Use button to select Envelope and press OK button.

Follow the instructions of any messages displayed to register the paper information.

11. Pull the paper output support (F) out from the paper output tray.

12. Open the output tray extension (G).

80
Note
• To prevent incorrect printing, this printer has a function that detects whether the information set for the
paper loaded matches the paper settings. Before printing, make paper settings in accordance with the
paper information. When this function is enabled, an error message is displayed if these settings do not
match to prevent incorrect printing. When this error message is displayed, check and correct the paper
settings.

81
Loading Originals

Where to Load Originals

Loading Originals on Platen

Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

Loading Based on Use

Supported Originals

82
Where to Load Originals

The printer has two positions to load originals: platen and ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

Select the position to load the original according to the size, type, or usage.

Note
• For details on the supported originals, see below.

Supported Originals

Loading Documents, Photos, or Book on Platen

Loading Two or More Sheets of Document of the Same Size and


Thickness in the ADF
You can also load a sheet of document in the ADF.

Note
• To scan the original at optimum quality, load it on the platen.

83
Loading Originals on Platen

1. Open the document cover.

2. Load original WITH SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN on platen.


Loading Based on Use
Supported Originals

Important
• Be sure to observe the following when loading the original on the platen.

Failure to observe the following may cause the scanner to malfunction or the platen glass to
break.

• Do not place any objects weighing 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass.

• Do not put any pressure of 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass, such as pressing down
the original.

3. Close the document cover gently.

84
Important
• After loading the original on the platen, be sure to close the document cover before starting to copy, fax,
or scan.

85
Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

Note
• To scan a document at optimum quality, load it on the platen.

1. Make sure any original has been removed from platen.

2. Open document tray (A).

3. Slide the paper guides (B) all the way out.

4. Load document WITH SIDE TO SCAN FACING UP in document tray.


Insert the document until it stops.

Note
• For details on the supported originals, see below.

Supported Originals

5. Adjust document guide (B) to match width of document.


Do not slide the document guide too hard against the document. The document may not be fed properly.

86
87
Loading Based on Use

Load the original in the correct position according to the function to use. If you do not load the original
correctly, it may not be scanned properly.

Originals Function How to Load

Magazines, Newspapers, and Copying or Faxing Loading the Original to Be


Documents Aligned with the alignment mark
Scanning by detecting the type and
size of the original automatically

If you scan using the operation panel,


press the SCAN button and select Auto
scan for Document type.

Scanning by specifying a standard


size (A4, Letter, etc.)

If you scan using the operation panel,


press the SCAN button, select Docu-
ment or Photo for Document type, and
then specify a standard size (A4, Letter,
etc.) for Scan size.

Photos, Postcards, Business Scanning only one original Loading Only One Original in
Cards, and Disc (BD/DVD/CD) Center of Platen
If you scan using the operation panel, fol-
low the operation below.
• Press the SCAN button and select
Auto scan for Document type.
• Press the SCAN button, select Photo
for Document type, and then specify
Auto scan(A) -Singl for Scan size.

Scanning two or more originals Loading Two or More Originals


on Platen
If you scan using the operation panel, fol-
low the operation below.

• Press the SCAN button and select


Auto scan for Document type.

• Press the SCAN button, select Photo


for Document type, and then specify
Auto scan(A) -Multi for Scan size.

Note
• For details on how to scan from the computer and how to load originals, see below.

• For Windows:

Scanning from Computer (Windows)


• For macOS:

Scanning from Computer (macOS)

88
Loading the Original to Be Aligned with the alignment mark
Place the original WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN on the platen and align it with the
alignment mark . Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.

Important
• The printer cannot scan the striped area (A) (0.04 inch (1 mm) from the edges of the platen glass).

Loading Only One Original in Center of Platen


Place the original WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN, with 0.40 inch (1 cm) or more space
between the edges (diagonally striped area) of the platen. Portions placed on the diagonally striped area
cannot be scanned.

89
Loading Two or More Originals on Platen
Place the originals WITH THE SIDE TO SCAN FACING DOWN. Allow 0.40 inch (1 cm) or more space
between the edges (diagonally striped area) of the platen and the originals, and between the originals.
Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.

You can place up to 12 items.

B: More than 0.40 inch (1 cm)

Note
• The Skew Correction function automatically compensates for the originals placed at an angle of up to
approximately 10 degrees. Slanted photos with a long edge of 7.1 inches (180 mm) or more cannot
be corrected.
• Non-rectangular or irregular shaped photos (such as cut out photos) may not be scanned properly.

90
Supported Originals

Platen
Item Details

Types of originals • Text document, magazine, or newspaper

• Printed photo, postcard, business card, or disc (BD/DVD/CD, etc.)

• Documents that are not suitable for the ADF

Size (width x height) Max. 8.5 x 11.7 inches (216 x 297 mm)

Quantity One or more sheets*

Thickness Max. 0.2 inch (5 mm)

* Two or more originals can be loaded on the platen depending on the selected function.

Loading Based on Use

In the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)


Item Details

Kind of original Plain-paper documents with multiple pages of the same size, thickness, and weight

Size A4, Letter, Legal

Duplex copying or 2-on-1/4-on-1 copying: A4/Letter only

Quantity • A4/Letter: Max. 20 sheets (20 lb. (75 g /m2) paper), up to 0.08 inch (2 mm) high

• Legal: Max. 5 sheets (20 lb. (75 g /m2) paper), up to 0.02 inch (0.5 mm) high

Thickness 0.003 to 0.005 inch (0.07 to 0.13 mm)

Weight 16.0 to 25.3 lb. (60 to 95 g /m2)

Note
• Make sure any liquids on documents, such as glue, ink, or correction fluid are dry before loading.
Do not load glued documents in the ADF, even if the glue is dry, because this may cause paper jams.

• Remove all staples, paper clips, or other fasteners before feeding documents.

• Load Legal-sized documents in the ADF.

• Do not load these kinds of documents in the ADF, which may cause paper jams.

• Wrinkled or creased documents

• Curled documents

• Torn documents

• Documents with holes

• Glued documents

• Documents with sticky notes

91
• Documents on carbon paper

• Documents on coated paper

• Documents on onion skin or other thin paper

• Photos or excessively thick documents

92
Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Checking Ink Status on the LCD

Ink Tips

93
Replacing a FINE Cartridge

When remaining ink cautions or errors occur, the error message will appear on the LCD to inform you of the
error. In this state, the printer cannot print or scan. Check the error message and take appropriate action.

An Error Occurs

While using the printer, the periphery of the paper output slot may become dirty with ink.

Before replacing the FINE Cartridge, clean the periphery of the paper output slot.

Replacing Procedure
When you need to replace a FINE cartridge, follow the procedure below.

Important
• Do not touch the electrical contacts (A) or print head nozzle (B) on a FINE cartridge. The printer may
not print properly if you touch them.

• If you remove a FINE cartridge, replace it immediately. Do not leave the printer with the FINE
cartridge removed.
• Use a new FINE cartridge for replacement. Installing a used FINE cartridge may cause the nozzles to
clog.
Furthermore, with such a FINE cartridge, the printer will not be able to inform you when to replace the
FINE cartridge properly.
• Once a FINE cartridge has been installed, do not remove it from the printer and leave it out in the
open. This will cause the FINE cartridge to dry out, and the printer may not operate properly when it
is reinstalled. To maintain optimal printing quality, use a FINE cartridge within six months of first use.

Note
• For Windows, if a FINE cartridge runs out of ink, you can print with either color or black FINE
cartridge, in whichever ink remains, only for a while. However the print quality may be reduced
compared to when printing with both cartridges. We recommend to use a new FINE cartridge in order
to obtain optimum qualities.

Even when printing with one ink only, print with leaving the empty FINE cartridge installed. If either of
the color FINE cartridge or black FINE cartridge is not installed, an error occurs and the printer
cannot print.

For information on how to configure this setting, see below.

94
Setting the FINE Cartridge to be Used

• Color ink may be consumed even when printing a black-and-white document or when black-and-
white printing is specified.

Both color ink and black ink are also consumed in the standard cleaning and deep cleaning of the
print head, which may be necessary to maintain the performance of the printer. When ink runs out,
replace the FINE cartridge immediately with a new one.

Ink Tips

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Open front cover (C).


The paper output tray (D) opens.

Note
• Remove any paper in the cassette.

3. Open the paper output cover.


The FINE cartridge holder (E) moves to the replacement position.

Caution
• Do not hold the FINE cartridge holder to stop or move it forcibly. Do not touch the FINE
cartridge holder until it stops completely.

95
Important
• The inside of the printer may be stained with ink. Be careful not to stain your hands or clothing
when replacing the FINE cartridge. You can easily wipe off the ink from the inside of the printer
with tissue paper or the like.
• Do not touch the metallic parts or other parts inside the printer.

• If the paper output cover is left open for more than 10 minutes, the FINE cartridge holder may
move and the Alarm lamp may light. In this case, close the paper output cover, and then open it
again.

4. Remove the empty FINE cartridge.

1. Push down the FINE cartridge until it clicks.

2. Remove the FINE cartridge.

Important
• Handle the FINE cartridge carefully to avoid staining of clothing or the surrounding area.

• Discard the empty FINE cartridge according to the local laws and regulations regarding disposal
of consumables.

5. Prepare a new FINE cartridge.

1. Take new FINE cartridge out of its package and remove protective tape (F) gently.

96
Important
• If you shake a FINE cartridge, ink may spill out and stain your hands and the surrounding area.
Handle a FINE cartridge carefully.

• Be careful not to stain your hands and the surrounding area with ink on the removed protective
tape.

• Do not reattach the protective tape once you have removed it. Discard it according to the local
laws and regulations regarding disposal of consumables.

• Do not touch the electrical contacts or print head nozzle on a FINE cartridge. The printer may
not print properly if you touch them.

6. Install the FINE cartridge.

1. Insert the new FINE cartridge at a slant into the FINE cartridge holder.
The color FINE cartridge should be installed into the left slot and the black FINE cartridge should be
installed into the right slot.

Important
• Insert the FINE cartridge gently so that it does not hit the electrical contacts on the FINE cartridge
holder.

97
2. Push the FINE cartridge in and up firmly until it snaps into place.

Important
• Check if the FINE cartridge is installed correctly.

98
• The printer cannot print unless both the color FINE cartridge and black FINE cartridge are
installed. Be sure to install both cartridges.

7. Close the paper output cover.

Note
• If the error message appears on the LCD after the paper output cover is closed, take
appropriate action.

An Error Occurs
• When you start printing after replacing the FINE cartridge, the printer starts cleaning the print
head automatically. Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the cleaning
of the print head.

• If the print head is out of alignment, as indicated by misaligned printed ruled lines or similar
symptoms, adjust the print head position.

• The printer may make noise during operation.

99
Checking Ink Status on the LCD

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press Setup button, use button to select Ink information, and then press OK button.
LCD and Operation Panel

3. Make sure Remaining ink appears and press OK button.


A in the figure below shows remaining ink level.

Example:
The ink is running low. Prepare a new ink cartridge.

The resulting print quality may not be satisfactory, if printing is continued under this condition.

Note
• You can also check the ink status on the LCD when you press the COPY or FAX button. The
current remaining ink level will be displayed on the LCD for a few seconds.

• You can also check the ink status on the computer screen.
• For Windows:

Checking Ink Status from Your Computer

• For macOS:

Checking Ink Status from Your Computer

100
Ink Tips

How is ink used for various purposes other than printing?


Ink may be used for purposes other than printing. Ink is not only used for printing, but also for cleaning the
print head to maintain the optimal printing quality.

The printer has the function to automatically clean the ink jet nozzles to prevent clogging. In the cleaning
procedure, used ink for nozzle cleaning is limited to a small amount.

Does black-and-white printing use color ink?


Black-and-white printing may use ink other than black ink depending on the type of printing paper or the
settings of the printer driver. So, color ink is consumed even when printing in black-and-white.

101
If Printing Is Faint or Uneven

Maintenance Procedure

Printing the Nozzle Check Pattern

Examining the Nozzle Check Pattern

Cleaning the Print Head

Deep Print Head Cleaning

Aligning the Print Head

102
Maintenance Procedure

If print results are blurred, colors are not printed correctly, or print results are unsatisfactory (e.g. misaligned
printed ruled lines), perform the maintenance procedure below.

Important
• Do not rinse or wipe the FINE cartridge. This can cause trouble with the FINE cartridge.

Note
• Check if ink remains in the FINE cartridge.

Checking the Ink Status on the LCD

• Check if the FINE cartridge is installed correctly.


Replacing Procedure

Also check if the protective tape on the bottom of the FINE cartridge is removed.

• If an error message appears on the LCD, see An Error Occurs.

• For Windows, increasing the print quality in the printer driver settings may improve the print result.

Changing the Print Quality and Correcting Image Data

When the Print Results Are Blurred or Uneven:

Step1 Print the nozzle check pattern.


From the printer

Printing the Nozzle Check Pattern

From the computer

• For Windows:

Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern

• For macOS:

Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern

Step2 Examine the nozzle check pattern.

103
If there are missing lines or horizontal white streaks in the pattern:

Step3 Clean the print head.


From the printer

Cleaning the Print Head

From the computer


• For Windows:

Cleaning the Print Heads


• For macOS:

Cleaning the Print Heads

After cleaning the print head, print and examine the nozzle check pattern: Step1

If the problem is not resolved after performing from step 1 to step 3 twice:

Step4 Clean the print head deeply.


From the printer
Deep Print Head Cleaning

From the computer

• For Windows:
Cleaning the Print Heads

• For macOS:
Cleaning the Print Heads

If the problem is not resolved, turn off the power and clean the print head deeply again after 24 hours. Do not
unplug the power cord when turning off the power.

If the problem is still not resolved:

Step5 Replace the FINE cartridge.


Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Note
• If the problem is still not resolved after replacing the FINE cartridge, contact your nearest Canon
service center to request a repair.

104
When the Print Results Are Not Even such as the Ruled Lines Are
Misaligned:

Step Align the print head.


From the printer

Aligning the Print Head

From the computer

• For Windows:
Adjusting Print Head Position Automatically
• For macOS:

Adjusting Print Head Position

105
Printing the Nozzle Check Pattern

Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzle.

Note
• If the remaining ink level is low, the nozzle check pattern will not be printed correctly. Replace the FINE
Cartridge whose ink is low.

You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in the cassette.


After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.
Select A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.

3. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray
extension.

4. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

5. Use the button to select Nozzle check and press the OK button.

The nozzle check pattern will be printed.

Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the printing of the nozzle check pattern.

6. Examine the nozzle check pattern.

106
Examining the Nozzle Check Pattern

Examine the nozzle check pattern, and clean the print head if necessary.

1. Check if there are missing lines in the pattern A or horizontal white streaks in the pattern B.

If there are missing lines in the pattern A:

C: Good
D: Bad (lines are missing)

If there are horizontal white streaks in the pattern B:

E: Good
F: Bad (horizontal white streaks are present)

If any color in the pattern A or the pattern B is not printed:

(Example: Magenta pattern is not printed)


Cleaning the print head is required.

107
Cleaning the Print Head

Clean the print head if lines are missing or if horizontal white streaks are present in the printed nozzle check
pattern. Cleaning unclogs the nozzles and restores the print head condition. Cleaning the print head
consumes ink, so clean the print head only when necessary.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

3. Use the button to select Cleaning and then press the OK button.

The printer starts cleaning the print head.

Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the cleaning of the print head. This takes
about 1 minute.

4. Examine the nozzle check pattern.

Note
• If the problem is not resolved after cleaning the print head twice, clean the print head deeply.

108
Deep Print Head Cleaning

If print quality does not improve by the standard cleaning of the print head, clean the print head deeply.
Cleaning the print head deeply consumes more ink than the standard cleaning of the print head, so clean
the print head deeply only when necessary.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

3. Use the button to select Deep cleaning and then press the OK button.

The printer starts cleaning the print head deeply.

Do not perform any other operations until the printer completes the deep cleaning of the print head. This
takes about 1 minute.

4. Examine the nozzle check pattern.


If the problem is not resolved, turn off the power and clean the print head deeply again after 24 hours. Do
not unplug the power cord when turning off the power.

If the problem is still not resolved, replace the FINE cartridge with a new one. If the problem is still not
resolved after replacing the FINE cartridge, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

109
Aligning the Print Head

If printed ruled lines are misaligned or print results are otherwise unsatisfactory, adjust the print head
position.

Note
• If the remaining ink level is low, the print head alignment sheet will not be printed correctly.

Replace the FINE cartridge whose ink is low.

You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in the cassette.


After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD.
Select A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.

3. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray
extension.

4. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

5. Use the button to select Head alignment and then press the OK button.

The print head alignment sheet will be printed.

110
Important
• Do not touch any printed part on the print head alignment sheet. If the sheet is stained or wrinkled,
it may not be scanned properly.

• If the print head alignment sheet was not printed correctly, press the Stop button, and redo this
procedure from the beginning.

6. Check message and place print head alignment sheet on platen.

Place the print head alignment sheet WITH THE PRINTED SIDE FACING DOWN and align the mark
on the upper left corner of the sheet with the alignment mark .

111
Note
• The print head alignment sheet cannot be scanned if it is loaded in the ADF (Auto Document
Feeder).

7. Close the document cover gently, then press the Black button or the Color button.
The printer starts scanning the print head alignment sheet, and the print head position will be adjusted
automatically.

After the print head position adjustment completion message is displayed, remove the print head
alignment sheet on the platen.

Important
• Do not open the document cover or move the print head alignment sheet on the platen until
adjusting the print head position is complete.

• If the error message appears on the LCD, press the OK button to release the error, then take
appropriate action.
An Error Occurs

Note
• For Windows, when the print results are still not satisfactory after adjusting the print head position as
described above, adjust the print head position manually from the computer.

Adjusting Print Head Position Manually


• To print and check the current head position adjustment values, select Print align value from the
Maintenance screen.

112
Performing Maintenance Functions from Your Computer
(macOS)

Opening Remote UI for Maintenance

Cleaning the Print Heads

Adjusting Print Head Position

Checking Ink Status from Your Computer

113
Opening Remote UI for Maintenance

You can perform maintenance of printer and change the settings from a Remote UI.
The following is the procedure to open a Remote UI.

1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners

2. Select your model from the printer list, and click Options & Supplies...

3. Click Show Printer Webpage... in General tab


Remote UI starts.

Note
• The password may have to be entered after Remote UI starts. In such a case, enter the password
and click OK. In case you do not know the password, click About password and cookies.

Related Topics
Cleaning the Print Heads
Adjusting Print Head Position
Checking Ink Status from Your Computer
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern
Managing the Printer Power
Changing the Printer Operation Mode
Reducing the Printer Noise

114
Cleaning the Print Heads

The print head cleaning function allows you to clear up clogged print head nozzle. Perform print head
cleaning if printing is faint or a specific color fails to print, even though there is enough ink.

Cleaning

1. Select Utilities from Remote UI

2. Click Cleaning
Before running the cleaning, check the following items:
Check whether the printer is on and open the printer's paper output cover.
Check the following items for each ink. Then, if necessary, perform Cleaning.

• Is there ink remaining in the cartridge?


• Did you push in the ink cartridge completely until you heard a clicking sound?
• If the orange tape is there, has it been peeled off completely?
Any remaining tape will hinder ink output.
• Did you install the ink cartridges in their correct positions?

3. Execute cleaning
Click Yes.

Print head cleaning starts.

4. Complete cleaning
Next, the message for nozzle check pattern printing is displayed.

5. Check the results


To check whether the print quality has improved, click Yes. To cancel the check process, click No.

If cleaning the head once does not resolve the print head problem, clean it once more.

Important
• Cleaning consumes a small amount of ink.
Cleaning the print head frequently will rapidly deplete your printer's ink supply. Consequently, perform
cleaning only when necessary.

Deep cleaning
Deep cleaning is more thorough than cleaning. Perform deep cleaning when two Cleaning attempts do
not resolve the print head problem.

1. Select Utilities from Remote UI

115
2. Click Deep cleaning
Before running the deep cleaning, check the following items:

Check whether the printer is on and open the printer's paper output cover.
Check the following items for each ink. Then, if necessary, perform Deep cleaning.

• Is there ink remaining in the cartridge?


• Did you push in the ink cartridge completely until you heard a clicking sound?
• If the orange tape is there, has it been peeled off completely?
Any remaining tape will hinder ink output.
• Did you install the ink cartridges in their correct positions?

3. Execute deep cleaning


Click Yes.
Print head deep cleaning starts.

4. Complete deep cleaning


Next, the message for nozzle check pattern printing is displayed.

5. Check the results


To check whether the print quality has improved, click Yes. To cancel the check process, click No.

Important
• Deep cleaning consumes a larger amount of ink than Cleaning.
Cleaning the print head frequently will rapidly deplete your printer's ink supply. Consequently, perform
cleaning only when necessary.

Note
• If there is no sign of improvement after Deep cleaning, turn off the printer, wait 24 hours, and then
perform Deep cleaning again. If there is still no sign of improvement, see "Ink Does Not Come Out."

Related Topic
Printing a Nozzle Check Pattern

116
Adjusting Print Head Position

Any error in the print head installation position can cause color and line shifts. Adjusting the print head
position improves print results.

Auto head alignment

1. Select Utilities from Remote UI

2. Click Auto head alignment


A message appears.

3. Load paper in printer


In the cassette, load 1 sheet of plain A4-sized or Letter-sized paper.

4. Run head position adjustment


Check that the printer power is on, and then click Yes.
Head alignment starts. Proceed with the operations in accordance with the messages on the screen.

Important
• Do not open the paper output cover while printing is in progress; otherwise, printing will stop.

Note
• You can print and check the current settings by clicking on Print the head alignment value.

117
Checking Ink Status from Your Computer

You can check the detailed information such as the remaining ink level and the FINE cartridge types of your
model.

If you select Printer status from Remote UI, the ink status appears as an illustration.
Estimated ink levels
You can check the types and levels of ink.
When ink levels are running low or an error occurs because there is no ink, a notification icon will
appear.

Ink number
You can look up the correct FINE cartridge for your printer.

Note
• To check the ink status, you can also display the pop-up menu of the Print dialog and select Supply
Levels.

118
Cleaning

Cleaning Exterior Surfaces

Cleaning Platen and Document Cover

Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers

Cleaning Inside the Printer (Bottom Plate Cleaning)

119
Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers

If the paper feed roller is dirty or paper powder is attached to it, paper may not be fed properly.

In this case, clean the paper feed roller. Cleaning will wear out the paper feed roller, so perform this only
when necessary.

You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper or cleaning sheet available on the
market

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Remove any paper from the cassette, then push it back.

Note
• If a message is displayed on the screen after pushing the cassette back, press the OK button.

3. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

4. Clean the paper feed rollers without paper.

1. Use the button to select Roller cleaning and then press the OK button.

The paper feed roller will rotate as it is cleaned without paper.

5. Clean the paper feed rollers with paper.

1. Make sure that the paper feed rollers have stopped rotating, then load a sheet of A4 or Letter-
sized plain paper or cleaning sheet available on the market in cassette.
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen appears on the LCD. Select A4
or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.

2. Pull out the paper output support from the paper output tray, then open the output tray
extension.

3. Make sure that Roller cleaning is selected, then press the OK button.
The printer starts cleaning. The cleaning will be complete when the paper is ejected.

120
If the problem is not resolved after cleaning the paper feed roller, contact your nearest Canon service center
to request a repair.

121
Cleaning Inside the Printer (Bottom Plate Cleaning)

Remove stains from the inside of the printer. If the inside of the printer becomes dirty, printed paper may get
dirty, so we recommend performing cleaning regularly.

You need to prepare: a sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper*

* Be sure to use a new piece of paper.

1. Make sure that the power is turned on, then remove any paper from the cassette.

2. Prepare paper.

1. Fold a single sheet of A4 or Letter-sized plain paper in half widthwise, then unfold the paper.

2. Fold one side of the opened paper in another half, aligning the edge with the center crease,
and then unfold the paper.

3. Load only this sheet of paper in the cassette with the ridges of the creases facing up and the
edge of the half with no crease facing to the far side.

* The above figure shows the printer with the paper output tray raised.
After pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen is displayed on the LCD. Select
A4 or Letter for Size: and Plain paper for Type: and then press the OK button.

4. Pull the paper output support out from the paper output tray, then open the output tray
extension.

122
3. Press the Setup button, use the button to select Maintenance, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

4. Use the button to select Bottom cleaning and then press the OK button.

The paper cleans the inside of the printer as it feeds through the printer.
Check the folded parts of the ejected paper. If they are smudged with ink, perform Bottom Plate Cleaning
again.

Note
• When performing Bottom Plate Cleaning again, be sure to use a new piece of paper.

If the problem is not resolved after performing cleaning again, the protrusions inside the printer may be
stained. Wipe off any ink from the protrusions using a cotton swab or the like.

Important
• Before cleaning the printer, turn it off and unplug it.

• The power cannot be turned off while the printer is sending or receiving a fax, or when unsent faxes
are stored in the printer's memory. Make sure the printer has finished sending or receiving faxes
before turning it off.
• Remember that faxes cannot be sent or received while the printer is off.

• Unplugging the printer will reset the date/time setting and erase all documents in the printer's
memory. Send faxes or print documents as needed before unplugging the printer.

123
Overview

Safety

Safety Precautions

Regulatory Information

WEEE (EU & EEA)

Handling Precautions

Canceling Print Jobs

Storing Printed Images

Legal Restrictions on Scanning/Copying

Transporting Your Printer

When Repairing, Lending, or Disposing of the Printer

Keeping Print Quality High

Main Components and Their Use

Main Components

Power Supply

LCD and Operation Panel

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

Changing Settings

Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (Windows)

Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (macOS)

Changing Settings from Operation Panel

Specifications

124
Safety

Safety Precautions

Regulatory Information

WEEE (EU&EEA)

125
Safety Precautions

Safety Precautions
• This manual contains important notices and safety precautions about your printer.

Do not use the printer in ways other than described in the accompanying manuals, as this may result
in fire, electric shock or other unexpected accidents.

Safety standard marks and declarations are only valid for the supported voltages and frequencies in
the applicable countries or regions.

Warning
• Users with cardiac pacemakers:
This product emits a low-level magnetic flux. If you feel abnormalities, please move away from the
product and consult your doctor.

• Do not use the printer in the following cases:

Stop use immediately, unplug the printer and call your local service representative to request repair.

• Metal objects or liquids are spilt inside the printer.


• The printer emits smoke, strange odors, or makes unusual noises.
• The power cord or plug overheat or are broken, bent or damaged in any way.

• Failure to adhere to the following may result in fire, electric shock, or injury:
• Do not place product close to the flammable solvents such as alcohol or thinner.
• Do not open or modify the printer.
• Use only the power cord/cables that came with your printer. Do not use these cables with other
devices.
• Do not plug in to voltages or frequencies other than those specified.
• Plug the power cord into the socket completely.
• Do not plug in or unplug the power cord with wet hands.
• Do not damage the power cord by twisting, bundling, tying, pulling or excessively bending it.
• Do not place heavy objects on the power cord.
• Do not connect multiple power cords to a single electrical outlet. Do not use multiple extension
cords.
• Do not leave the printer plugged in during lightning storms.
• Always unplug the power cord and cables when cleaning. Do not use flammable sprays or liquids
such as alcohol or thinners for cleaning.
• Unplug the power cord once a month to check that it is not overheating, rusted, bent, scratched,
split, or otherwise damaged.

Caution
• Do not put your hands inside the printer while printing.
• Do not touch the print head or other metal parts immediately after printing.
• Ink
• Keep ink out of reach of children.
• If ink is accidentally licked or swallowed, rinse out your mouth and drink one or two glasses of
water. If irritation or discomfort occurs, obtain medical advice immediately.

126
• In case ink gets in contact with eyes, rinse with water immediately. In case ink gets in contact
with skin, wash with soap and water immediately. If irritation to eyes or skin persists, obtain
medical advice immediately.

• Moving the printer


• Do not hold the printer by the cassette. Hold the printer by its sides and carry it with both hands.

General Notices

Choosing a Location
Refer to "Specifications" in the Online manual for details on operating environment.

• Do not install the printer in a location that is unstable or subject to excessive vibration.
• Do not install the printer in locations that get very hot (direct sunlight, or close to a heating source),
very humid or dusty locations, or outdoors.
• Do not place the printer on a thick rug or carpet.
• Do not place the printer flush against a wall.

Power Supply
• Keep the area around the power outlet clear at all times so you can easily unplug the power cord if
necessary.
• Never remove the plug by pulling on the cord.

127
General Notices
• Do not tilt the printer, stand it on end, or turn it upside down. This may cause ink to leak.
• Do not place anything on top of the printer. Be especially careful to avoid metal objects such as
paper clips and staples, and containers holding flammable liquids such as alcohol or thinner.
• Do not apply excessive pressure when placing large objects on the platen glass.
• Do not attempt to open, disassemble or modify the FINE cartridges. Ink may leak and damage your
printer.
• Do not throw FINE cartridges in the fire.

128
Regulatory Information

IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS


SAVE THESE INSTRUCTIONS

When using your telephone equipment, basic safety precautions should always be followed to reduce the
risk of fire, electric shock and injury to persons, including the following:

1. Do not use this product near water, for example, near a bath tub, wash bowl, kitchen sink or laundry
tub, in a wet basement or near a swimming pool.
2. Avoid using this product during an electrical storm. There may be a remote risk of electric shock from
lightning.
3. Do not use this product to report a gas leak in the vicinity of the leak.
"CAUTION - To reduce the risk of fire, use only No. 26 AWG or larger telecommunication line cord."

IMPORTANTES MESURES DE SÉCURITÉ


CONSERVER CES INSTRUCTIONS

Certaines mesures de sécurité doivent être prises pendant l'utilisation de matérial téléphonique afin de
réduire les risques d'incendie, de choc électrique et de blessures.

En voice quelquesunes :
1. Ne pas utiliser l'appareil près de l'eau, p.ex., près d'une baignoire, d'un lavabo, d'un évier de cuisine,
d'un bac à laver, dans un sous-sol humide ou près d'une piscine.
2. Éviter d'utiliser l'appareil pendant un orage électrique. Ceci peut présenter un risque de choc
électrique causé par la foudre.
3. Ne pas utiliser l'appareil pour signaler une fuite de gaz s'il est situé près de la fuite.

"ATTENTION - Pour réduire les risques d'incendie, utiliser uniquement des conducteurs de
télécommunications 26 AWG au de section supérleure."

Users in the U.S.A.


FCC Notice (U.S.A. Only)
For 120V, 60Hz model
Model Number: K10483 (Contains FCC Approved WLAN Module K30365)

This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference
received, including interference that may cause undesired operation.

Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against
harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio
frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful
interference to radio communications.
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment
does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the

129
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the
following measures:

• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.


• Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is
connected.
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help.
Use of a shielded cable is required to comply with Class B limits in Subpart B of Part 15 of the FCC Rules.

Do not make any changes or modifications to the equipment unless otherwise specified in the manual. If
such changes or modifications should be made, you could be required to stop operation of the equipment.

FCC ID:AZDK30365

Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the
user's authority to operate equipment.

This transmitter must not be co-located or operating in conjunction with any other antenna or transmitter.

The equipment complies with FCC radiation exposure limits for at uncontrolled equipment. This
equipment should be installed and operated with minimum distance at least 20cm between the radiator
and persons body (excluding extremities: hands, wrists, feet and ankles) and must not be colocated or
operated with any other antenna or transmitter.

Canon U.S.A., Inc.


One Canon Park
Melville, New York 11747
1-800-652-2666

Interference
Do not use the printer around medical equipment or other electronic devices. Signals from the printer may
interfere with the correct operation of these devices.

Pre-Installation Requirements

Order Information

When ordering service from the telephone company for this equipment, the following may be required.

Universal Service Order Code (USOC): RJ11C

The Facility Interface Code (FIC): 02LS2

Service Order Code (SOC): 9.0F

Connection of the Equipment


This equipment complies with Part 68 of the FCC rules and the requirements adopted by the ACTA.

A label on this equipment contains, among other information, a product identifier in the format
US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. If requested, this number must be provided to the telephone company.

The REN is used to determine the number of devices that may be connected to a telephone line.

130
Excessive RENs on a telephone line may result in the devices not ringing in response to an incoming call.
In most but not all areas, the sum of RENs should not exceed five (5.0). To be certain of the number of
devices that may be connected to a line, as determined by the total RENs, contact the local telephone
company. The REN for this product is part of the product identifier that has the format
US:AAAEQ##TXXXX. The digits represented by ## are the REN without a decimal point (e.g., 03 is a
REN of 0.3).

A plug and jack used to connect this equipment to the premises wiring and telephone network must
comply with the applicable FCC Part 68 rules and requirements adopted by the ACTA. A compliant
telephone cord and modular plug is provided with this product. It is designed to be connected to a
compatible modular jack that is also compliant. See installation instructions for details.

Connection to party lines is subjected to state tariffs. Contact the state public utility commission, public
service commission or corporation commission for information.
If your home has specially wired alarm equipment connected to the telephone line, ensure the installation
of this equipment does not disable your alarm equipment. If you have questions about what will disable
alarm equipment, consult your telephone company or a qualified installer.

In Case of Equipment Malfunction


Should any malfunction occur which cannot be corrected by the procedures described in the Online
Manual, disconnect the equipment from the telephone line cable, turn off the power and disconnect the
power cord. The telephone line cable should not be reconnected or the main power switch turned ON until
the problem is completely resolved. Users should contact their local authorized Canon Facsimile Service
Dealer for the servicing of equipment.

Information regarding Authorized Service Facility locations can be obtained by calling the Canon
Customer Center.

Rights of the Telephone Company


If this equipment causes harm to the telephone network, the telephone company may temporarily
disconnect service. The telephone company also retains the right to make changes in facilities and
services that may affect the operation of this equipment. When such changes are necessary, the
telephone company is required to give adequate prior notice to the user. However, if advance notice is not
possible, the telephone company will notify the customer as soon as possible. Also, the customer will be
advised of his/her right to file a compliant with the FCC if he/she believes it is necessary.

Warning

The Telephone Consumer Protection Act of 1991 makes it unlawful for any person to use a computer or
other electronic device to send any message via a telephone FAX machine unless such message clearly
contains in a margin at the top or bottom of each transmitted page, or on the first page of the
transmission, the date and time it is sent and an identification of the business or other entity, or other
individual sending the message and the telephone number of the sending machine or such business,
other entity, or individual.

In order to program this information into your FAX machine, you should complete the procedure to register
your name, unit's telephone number, time, and date. Refer to the Online Manual.

131
WEEE (EU&EEA)

Only for European Union and EEA (Norway, Iceland and Liechtenstein)

This symbol indicates that this product is not to be disposed of with your household waste, according to
the WEEE Directive (2012/19/EU) and national legislation. This product should be handed over to a
designated collection point, e.g., on an authorized one-for-one basis when you buy a new similar product
or to an authorized collection site for recycling waste electrical and electronic equipment (EEE). Improper
handling of this type of waste could have a possible negative impact on the environment and human
health due to potentially hazardous substances that are generally associated with EEE. At the same time,
your cooperation in the correct disposal of this product will contribute to the effective usage of natural
resources. For more information about where you can drop off your waste equipment for recycling, please
contact your local city office, waste authority, approved WEEE scheme or your household waste disposal
service. For more information regarding return and recycling of WEEE products, please visit www.canon-
europe.com/weee.

Nur für Europäische Union und EWR (Norwegen, Island und


Liechtenstein)

Dieses Symbol weist darauf hin, dass dieses Produkt gemäß der EU-Richtlinie über Elektro- und
Elektronik-Altgeräte (2012/19/EU) und nationalen Gesetzen nicht über den Hausmüll entsorgt werden
darf. Dieses Produkt muss bei einer dafür vorgesehenen Sammelstelle abgegeben werden. Dies kann z.
B. durch Rückgabe beim Kauf eines ähnlichen Produkts oder durch Abgabe bei einer autorisierten
Sammelstelle für die Wiederaufbereitung von Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten geschehen. Der
unsachgemäße Umgang mit Altgeräten kann aufgrund potentiell gefährlicher Stoffe, die generell mit
Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten in Verbindung stehen, negative Auswirkungen auf die Umwelt und die
menschliche Gesundheit haben. Durch die umweltgerechte Entsorgung dieses Produkts tragen Sie
außerdem zu einer effektiven Nutzung natürlicher Ressourcen bei. Informationen zu Sammelstellen für
Altgeräte erhalten Sie bei Ihrer Stadtverwaltung, dem öffentlich-rechtlichen Entsorgungsträger, einer
autorisierten Stelle für die Entsorgung von Elektro- und Elektronik-Altgeräten oder Ihrem örtlichen
Entsorgungsunternehmen. Weitere Informationen zur Rückgabe und Entsorgung von Elektro- und
Elektronik-Altgeräten finden Sie unter www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Union Européenne, Norvège, Islande et Liechtenstein uniquement.

132
Ce symbole indique que ce produit ne doit pas être jeté avec les ordures ménagères, conformément à la
directive DEEE (2012/19/UE) et à la réglementation de votre pays. Ce produit doit être confié au
distributeur à chaque fois que vous achetez un produit neuf similaire, ou à un point de collecte mis en
place par les collectivités locales pour le recyclage des Déchets des Équipements Électriques et
Électroniques (DEEE). Le traitement inapproprié de ce type de déchet risque d'avoir des répercussions
sur l'environnement et la santé humaine, du fait de la présence de substances potentiellement
dangereuses généralement associées aux équipements électriques et électroniques. Parallèlement, votre
entière coopération dans le cadre de la mise au rebut correcte de ce produit favorisera une meilleure
utilisation des ressources naturelles. Pour plus d'informations sur les points de collecte des équipements
à recycler, contactez vos services municipaux, les autorités locales compétentes, le plan DEEE approuvé
ou le service d'enlèvement des ordures ménagères. Pour plus d'informations sur le retour et le recyclage
des produits DEEE, consultez le site: www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Uitsluitend bestemd voor de Europese Unie en EER (Noorwegen,


IJsland en Liechtenstein)

Dit symbool geeft aan dat dit product in overeenstemming met de AEEA-richtlijn (2012/19/EU) en de
nationale wetgeving niet mag worden afgevoerd met het huishoudelijk afval. Dit product moet worden
ingeleverd bij een aangewezen, geautoriseerd inzamelpunt, bijvoorbeeld wanneer u een nieuw
gelijksoortig product aanschaft, of bij een geautoriseerd inzamelpunt voor hergebruik van elektrische en
elektronische apparatuur (EEA). Een onjuiste afvoer van dit type afval kan leiden tot negatieve effecten op
het milieu en de volksgezondheid als gevolg van potentieel gevaarlijke stoffen die veel voorkomen in
elektrische en elektronische apparatuur (EEA). Bovendien werkt u door een juiste afvoer van dit product
mee aan het effectieve gebruik van natuurlijke hulpbronnen. Voor meer informatie over waar u uw
afgedankte apparatuur kunt inleveren voor recycling kunt u contact opnemen met het gemeentehuis in uw
woonplaats, de reinigingsdienst, of het afvalverwerkingsbedrijf. U kunt ook het schema voor de afvoer van
afgedankte elektrische en elektronische apparatuur (AEEA) raadplegen. Ga voor meer informatie over het
inzamelen en recyclen van afgedankte elektrische en elektronische apparatuur naar www.canon-
europe.com/weee.

Sólo para la Unión Europea y el Área Económica Europea (Noruega,


Islandia y Liechtenstein)

Este símbolo indica que este producto no debe desecharse con los desperdicios domésticos, de acuerdo
con la directiva RAEE (2012/19/UE) y con la legislación nacional. Este producto debe entregarse en uno
de los puntos de recogida designados, como por ejemplo, entregándolo en el lugar de venta al comprar
un producto similar o depositándolo en un lugar de recogida autorizado para el reciclado de residuos de
aparatos eléctricos y electrónicos (RAEE). La manipulación inapropiada de este tipo de desechos podría
tener un impacto negativo en el entorno y la salud humana, debido a las sustancias potencialmente

133
peligrosas que normalmente están asociadas con los RAEE. Al mismo tiempo, su cooperación a la hora
de desechar correctamente este producto contribuirá a la utilización eficazde los recursos naturales. Para
más información sobre cómo puede eliminar el equipo para su reciclado, póngase en contacto con las
autoridades locales, con las autoridades encargadas de los desechos, con un sistema de gestión RAEE
autorizado o con el servicio de recogida de basuras doméstico. Si desea más información acerca de la
devolución y reciclado de RAEE, visite la web www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Només per a la Unió Europea i a l’Espai Econòmic Europeu (Noruega,


Islàndia i Liechtenstein)

Aquest símbol indica que aquest producte no s’ha de llençar a les escombraries de la llar, d’acord amb la
Directiva RAEE (2012/19/UE) i la legislació nacional. Aquest producte s’hauria de lliurar en un dels punts
de recollida designats, com per exemple, intercanviant-lo un per un en comprar un producte similar o
lliurant-lo en un lloc de recollida autoritzat per al reciclatge de residus d’aparells elèctrics i electrònics
(AEE). La manipulació inadequada d’aquest tipus de residus podria tenir un impacte negatiu en l’entorn i
en la salut humana, a causa de les substàncies potencialment perilloses que normalment estan
associades als AEE. Així mateix, la vostra cooperació a l’hora de llençar correctament aquest producte
contribuirà a la utilització efectiva dels recursos naturals. Per a més informació sobre els punts on podeu
lliurar aquest producte per procedir al seu reciclatge, adreceu-vos a la vostra oficina municipal, a les
autoritats encarregades dels residus, al pla de residus homologat per la RAEE o al servei de recollida de
deixalles domèstiques de la vostra localitat. Per a més informació sobre la devolució i el reciclatge de
productes RAEE, visiteu www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Solo per Unione Europea e SEE (Norvegia, Islanda e Liechtenstein)

Questo simbolo indica che il prodotto deve essere oggetto di raccolta separata in conformità alla Direttiva
RAEE (2012/19/UE) e alla normativa locale vigente. Il prodotto deve essere smaltito presso un centro di
raccolta differenziata, un distributore autorizzato che applichi il principio dell'"uno contro uno", ovvero del
ritiro della vecchia apparecchiatura elettrica al momento dell'acquisto di una nuova, o un impianto
autorizzato al riciclaggio dei rifiuti di apparecchiature elettriche ed elettroniche. La gestione impropria di
questo tipo di rifiuti può avere un impatto negativo sull'ambiente e sulla salute umana causato dalle
sostanze potenzialmente pericolose che potrebbero essere contenute nelle apparecchiature elettriche ed
elettroniche. Un corretto smaltimento di tali prodotti contribuirà inoltre a un uso efficace delle risorse
naturali ed eviterà di incorrere nelle sanzioni amministrative di cui all'art. 255 e successivi del Decreto
Legislativo n. 152/06. Per ulteriori informazioni sullo smaltimento e il recupero dei Rifiuti di
Apparecchiature Elettriche ed Elettroniche, consultare la Direttiva RAEE, rivolgersi alle autorità
competenti, oppure visitare il sito www.canon-europe.com/weee.

134
Apenas para a União Europeia e AEE (Noruega, Islândia e
Liechtenstein)

Este símbolo indica que o produto não deve ser colocado no lixo doméstico, de acordo com a Directiva
REEE (2012/19/UE) e a legislação nacional. Este produto deverá ser colocado num ponto de recolha
designado, por exemplo, num local próprio autorizado quando adquirir um produto semelhante novo ou
num local de recolha autorizado para reciclar resíduos de equipamentos eléctricos e electrónicos (EEE).
O tratamento inadequado deste tipo de resíduo poderá causar um impacto negativo no ambiente e na
saúde humana devido às substâncias potencialmente perigosas normalmente associadas aos
equipamentos eléctricos e electrónicos. Simultaneamente, a sua cooperação no tratamento correcto
deste produto contribuirá para a utilização eficaz dos recursos naturais. Para mais informações sobre os
locais onde o equipamento poderá ser reciclado, contacte os serviços locais, a autoridade responsável
pelos resíduos, o esquema REEE aprovado ou o serviço de tratamento de lixo doméstico. Para mais
informações sobre a devolução e reciclagem de produtos REEE, vá a www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Gælder kun i Europæiske Union og EØS (Norge, Island og


Liechtenstein)

Dette symbol angiver, at det pågældende produkt ikke må bortskaffes sammen med dagrenovation jf.
direktivet om affald af elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr (WEEE) (2012/19/EU) og gældende national
lovgivning. Det pågældende produkt skal afleveres på et nærmere specificeret indsamlingssted, f.eks. i
overensstemmelse med en godkendt én-til-én-procedure, når du indkøber et nyt tilsvarende produkt, eller
produktet skal afleveres på et godkendt indsamlingssted for elektronikaffald. Forkert håndtering af denne
type affald kan medføre negative konsekvenser for miljøet og menneskers helbred på grund af de
potentielt sundhedsskadelige stoffer, der generelt kan forefindes i elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr. Når du
foretager korrekt bortskaffelse af det pågældende produkt, bidrager du til effektiv brug af
naturressourcerne. Yderligere oplysninger om, hvor du kan bortskaffe dit elektronikaffald med henblik på
genanvendelse, får du hos de kommunale renovationsmyndigheder. Yderligere oplysninger om
returnering og genanvendelse af affald af elektrisk og elektronisk udstyr får du ved at besøge www.canon-
europe.com/weee.

Μόνο για την Ευρωπαϊκή Ένωση και τον ΕΟΧ (Νορβηγία, Ισλανδία και
Λιχτενστάιν)

135
Αυτό το σύμβολο υποδηλώνει ότι αυτό το προϊόν δεν πρέπει να απορρίπτεται μαζί με τα οικιακά
απορρίμματα, σύμφωνα με την Οδηγία σχετικά με τα Απόβλητα Ηλεκτρικού και Ηλεκτρονικού Εξοπλισμού
(ΑΗΗΕ) (2012/19/ΕΕ) και την εθνική σας νομοθεσία. Αυτό το προϊόν πρέπει να παραδίδεται σε
καθορισμένο σημείο συλλογής, π.χ. σε μια εξουσιοδοτημένη βάση ανταλλαγής όταν αγοράζετε ένα νέο
παρόμοιο προϊόν ή σε μια εξουσιοδοτημένη θέση συλλογής για την ανακύκλωση των αποβλήτων
Ηλεκτρικού και Ηλεκτρονικού Εξοπλισμού (ΗΗΕ). Ο ακατάλληλος χειρισμός αυτού του τύπου αποβλήτων
μπορεί να έχει αρνητικό αντίκτυπο στο περιβάλλον και την υγεία του ανθρώπου, λόγω δυνητικώς
επικίνδυνων ουσιών που γενικά συνδέονται με τον ΗΗΕ. Ταυτόχρονα, η συνεργασία σας όσον αφορά τη
σωστή απόρριψη αυτού του προϊόντος θα συμβάλει στην αποτελεσματική χρήση των φυσικών πόρων.
Για περισσότερες πληροφορίες σχετικά με τα σημεία όπου μπορείτε να απορρίψετε τον εξοπλισμό σας για
ανακύκλωση, επικοινωνήστε με το τοπικό γραφείο της πόλης σας, την υπηρεσία απορριμμάτων, το
εγκεκριμένο σχήμα ΑΗΗΕ ή την υπηρεσία απόρριψης οικιακών αποβλήτων. Για περισσότερες
πληροφορίες σχετικά με την επιστροφή και την ανακύκλωση των προϊόντων ΑΗΗΕ, επισκεφθείτε την
τοποθεσία www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Gjelder kun den europeiske union og EØS (Norge, Island og


Liechtenstein)

Dette symbolet indikerer at dette produktet ikke skal kastes sammen med husholdningsavfall, i henhold til
WEEE-direktiv (2012/19/EU) og nasjonal lov. Produktet må leveres til et dertil egnet innsamlingspunkt, det
vil si på en autorisert en-til-en-basis når du kjøper et nytt lignende produkt, eller til et autorisert
innsamlingssted for resirkulering av avfall fra elektrisk og elektronisk utstyr (EE-utstyr). Feil håndtering av
denne typen avfall kan være miljø- og helseskadelig på grunn av potensielt skadelige stoffer som ofte
brukes i EE-utstyr. Samtidig bidrar din innsats for korrekt avhending av produktet til effektiv bruk av
naturressurser. Du kan få mer informasjon om hvor du kan avhende utrangert utstyr til resirkulering ved å
kontakte lokale myndigheter, et godkjent WEEE-program eller husholdningens renovasjonsselskap. Du
finner mer informasjon om retur og resirkulering av WEEE-produkter på www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Vain Euroopan unionin sekä ETA:n (Norja, Islanti ja Liechtenstein)


alueelle.

Tämä tunnus osoittaa, että sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromua koskeva direktiivi (SER-direktiivi,


2012/19/EU) sekä kansallinen lainsäädäntö kieltävät tuotteen hävittämisen talousjätteen mukana. Tuote
on vietävä asianmukaiseen keräyspisteeseen, esimerkiksi kodinkoneliikkeeseen uutta vastaavaa tuotetta
ostettaessa tai viralliseen sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun keräyspisteeseen. Sähkö- ja
elektroniikkalaiteromun virheellinen käsittely voi vahingoittaa ympäristöä ja ihmisten terveyttä, koska
laitteet saattavat sisältää ympäristölle ja terveydelle haitallisia aineita. Lisäksi tuotteen asianmukainen
hävittäminen säästää luonnonvaroja. Lisätietoja sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun keräyspisteistä saat
kaupunkien ja kuntien tiedotuksesta, jätehuoltoviranomaisilta, sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun

136
kierrätysjärjestelmän ylläpitäjältä ja jätehuoltoyhtiöltä. Lisätietoja sähkö- ja elektroniikkalaiteromun
keräyksestä ja kierrätyksestä on osoitteessa www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Endast för Europeiska unionen och EES (Norge, Island och


Liechtenstein)

Den här symbolen visar att produkten enligt WEEE-direktivet (2012/19/EU) och nationell lagstiftning inte
får sorteras och slängas som hushållsavfall. Den här produkten ska lämnas in på en därför avsedd
insamlingsplats, t.ex. på en återvinningsstation auktoriserad att hantera elektrisk och elektronisk
utrustning (EE-utrustning) eller hos handlare som är auktoriserade att byta in varor då nya, motsvarande
köps (en mot en). Olämplig hantering av avfall av den här typen kan ha en negativ inverkan på miljön och
människors hälsa på grund av de potentiellt farliga ämnen som kan återfinnas i elektrisk och elektronisk
utrustning. Din medverkan till en korrekt avfallshantering av den här produkten bidrar dessutom till en
effektiv användning av naturresurserna. Kontakta ditt lokala kommunkontor, berörd myndighet, företag för
avfallshantering eller ta del av en godkänd WEEE-organisation om du vill ha mer information om var du
kan lämna den kasserade produkten för återvinning. För mer information om inlämning och återvinning av
WEEE-produkter, se www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Pouze Evropská unie a EHP (Norsko, Island a Lichtenštejnsko)

Tento symbol znamená, že podle směrnice o OEEZ (2012/19/EU) a podle vnitrostátních právních
předpisů nemá být tento výrobek likvidován s odpadem z domácností. Tento výrobek má být vrácen do
sběrného místa, např. v rámci autorizovaného systému odběru jednoho výrobku za jeden nově prodaný
podobný výrobek nebo v autorizovaném sběrném místě pro recyklaci odpadních elektrických a
elektronických zařízení (OEEZ). Nevhodné nakládání s tímto druhem odpadu by mohlo mít negativní
dopad na životní prostředí a lidské zdraví, protože elektrická a elektronická zařízení zpravidla obsahují
potenciálně nebezpečné látky. Vaše spolupráce na správné likvidaci tohoto výrobku současně napomůže
efektivnímu využívání přírodních zdrojů. Další informace o místech sběru vašeho odpadního zařízení
k recyklaci vám sdělí místní úřad vaší obce, správní orgán vykonávající dozor nad likvidací odpadu,
sběrny OEEZ nebo služba pro odvoz komunálního odpadu. Další informace týkající se vracení a
recyklace OEEZ naleznete na adrese www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Csak az Európai Unió és az EGT (Norvégia, Izland és Liechtenstein)


országaiban

137
Ez a szimbólum azt jelzi, hogy a helyi törvények és a WEEE-irányelv (2012/19/EU) szerint a termék nem
kezelhető háztartási hulladékként. A terméket a kijelölt nyilvános gyűjtőpontokon kell leadni, például
hasonló cserekészülék vásárlásakor, illetve bármelyik, elektromos és elektronikai berendezésekből
származó hulladék (WEEE) átvételére feljogosított gyűjtőponton. Az ilyen jellegű hulladékok a nem
megfelelő kezelés esetén a bennük található veszélyes anyagok révén ártalmasak lehetnek a környezetre
és az emberek egészségére. Továbbá, a termékből származó hulladék megfelelő kezelésével
hozzájárulhat a természetes nyersanyagok hatékonyabb hasznosításához. A berendezésekből származó,
újrahasznosítható hulladékok elhelyezésére vonatkozó további tudnivalókért forduljon a helyi
önkormányzathoz, a közterület-fenntartó vállalathoz, a háztartási hulladék begyűjtését végző vállalathoz,
illetve a hivatalos WEEE-képviselethez. További tudnivalókat a WEEE-termékek visszajuttatásáról és
újrahasznosításáról a www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Tylko dla krajów Unii Europejskiej oraz EOG (Norwegia, Islandia i


Liechtenstein)

Ten symbol oznacza, że zgodnie z dyrektywą WEEE dotyczącą zużytego sprzętu elektrycznego i
elektronicznego (2012/19/UE) oraz przepisami lokalnymi nie należy wyrzucać tego produktu razem z
odpadami gospodarstwa domowego. Produkt należy przekazać do wyznaczonego punktu gromadzenia
odpadów, np. firmie, od której kupowany jest nowy, podobny produkt lub do autoryzowanego punktu
gromadzenia zużytego sprzętu elektrycznego i elektronicznego w celu poddania go recyklingowi.
Usuwanie tego typu odpadów w nieodpowiedni sposób może mieć negatywny wpływ na otoczenie i
zdrowie innych osób ze względu na niebezpieczne substancje stosowane w takim sprzęcie. Jednocześnie
pozbycie się zużytego sprzętu w zalecany sposób przyczynia się do właściwego wykorzystania zasobów
naturalnych. Aby uzyskać więcej informacji na temat punktów, do których można dostarczyć sprzęt do
recyklingu, prosimy skontaktować się z lokalnym urzędem miasta, zakładem utylizacji odpadów,
skorzystać z instrukcji zatwierdzonej dyrektywą WEEE lub skontaktować się z przedsiębiorstwem
zajmującym się wywozem odpadów domowych. Więcej informacji o zwracaniu i recyklingu zużytego
sprzętu elektrycznego i elektronicznego znajduje się w witrynie www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Platí len pre štáty Európskej únie a EHP (Nórsko, Island a


Lichtenštajnsko)

Tento symbol znamená, že podľa Smernice 2012/19/EÚ o odpade z elektrických a elektronických


zariadení (OEEZ) a podľa platnej legislatívy Slovenskej republiky sa tento produkt nesmie likvidovať spolu
s komunálnym odpadom. Produkt je potrebné odovzdať do určenej zberne, napr. prostredníctvom výmeny
za kúpu nového podobného produktu, alebo na autorizované zberné miesto, ktoré spracúva odpad z
elektrických a elektronických zariadení (EEZ). Nesprávna manipulácia s takýmto typom odpadu môže mať
negatívny vplyv na životné prostredie a ľudské zdravie, pretože elektrické a elektronické zariadenia
obsahujú potenciálne nebezpečné látky. Spoluprácou na správnej likvidácii produktu prispejete

138
k účinnému využívaniu prírodných zdrojov. Ďalšie informácie o mieste recyklácie opotrebovaných
zariadení získate od miestneho úradu, úradu životného prostredia, zo schváleného plánu OEEZ alebo od
spoločnosti, ktorá zaisťuje likvidáciu komunálneho odpadu. Viac informácií nájdete aj na webovej stránke:
www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Üksnes Euroopa Liit ja EMP (Norra, Island ja Liechtenstein)

See sümbol näitab, et antud toodet ei tohi vastavalt elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmete jäätmeid käsitlevale
direktiivile (2012/19/EL) ning teie riigis kehtivatele õigusaktidele utiliseerida koos olmejäätmetega. Antud
toode tuleb anda selleks määratud kogumispunkti, nt müügipunkt, mis on volitatud üks ühe vastu
vahetama, kui ostate uue sarnase toote, või elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmete jäätmete ümbertöötlemiseks
mõeldud kogumispunkti. Täiendava teabe saamiseks elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmetest tekkinud jäätmete
tagastamise ja ümbertöötlemise kohta võtke ühendust kohaliku omavalitsusega, asjakohase
valitsusasutusega, asjakohase tootjavastutusorganisatsiooniga või olmejäätmete käitlejaga. Lisateavet
leitate ka Interneti-leheküljelt www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Tikai Eiropas Savienībai un EEZ (Norvēģijai, Islandei un Lihtenšteinai)

Šis simbols norāda, ka atbilstoši ES Direktīvai (2012/19/ES) par elektrisko un elektronisko iekārtu
atkritumiem (EEIA) un vietējiem tiesību aktiem no šī izstrādājuma nedrīkst atbrīvoties, izmetot to kopā ar
sadzīves atkritumiem. Šis izstrādājums ir jānodod piemērotā savākšanas vietā, piemēram, apstiprinātā
veikalā, kur iegādājaties līdzīgu jaunu produktu un atstājat veco, vai apstiprinātā vietā izlietotu elektrisko
un elektronisko iekārtu pārstrādei. Nepareiza šāda veida atkritumu apsaimniekošana var apdraudēt vidi
un cilvēka veselību tādu iespējami bīstamu vielu dēļ, kas parasti ir elektriskajās un elektroniskajās
iekārtās. Turklāt jūsu atbalsts pareizā šāda veida atkritumu apsaimniekošanā sekmēs efektīvu dabas
resursu izmantošanu. Lai saņemtu pilnīgāku informāciju par vietām, kur izlietoto iekārtu var nodot
pārstrādei, sazinieties ar vietējo pašvaldību, atkritumu savākšanas atbildīgo dienestu, pilnvarotu EEIA
struktūru vai sadzīves atkritumu apsaimniekošanas iestādi. Lai saņemtu plašāku informāciju par elektrisko
un elektronisko iekārtu nodošanu pārstrādei, apmeklējiet tīmekļa vietni www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Tik Europos Sąjungai ir EEE (Norvegijai, Islandijai ir Lichtenšteinui)

Šis ženklas reiškia, kad gaminio negalima išmesti su buitinėmis atliekomis, kaip yra nustatyta Direktyvoje
(2012/19/ES) ir nacionaliniuose teisė aktuose dėl EEĮ atliekų tvarkymo. Šį gaminį reikia atiduoti į tam
skirtą surinkimo punktą, pvz., pagal patvirtintą keitimo sistemą, kai perkamas panašus gaminys, arba į

139
elektros ir elektroninės įrangos (EEĮ) atliekų perdirbimo punktą. Netinkamas tokios rūšies atliekų
tvarkymas dėl elektros ir elektroninėje įrangoje esančių pavojingų medžiagų gali pakenkti aplinkai ir
žmonių sveikatai. Padėdami užtikrinti tinkamą šio gaminio šalinimo tvarką, kartu prisidėsite prie
veiksmingo gamtos išteklių naudojimo. Jei reikia daugiau informacijos, kaip šalinti tokias atliekas, kad jos
būtų toliau perdirbamos, kreipkitės į savo miesto valdžios institucijas, atliekų tvarkymo organizacijas,
patvirtintų EEĮ atliekų sistemų arba jūsų buitinių atliekų tvarkymo įstaigų atstovus. Išsamesnės
informacijos apie EEĮ atliekų grąžinimo ir perdirbimo tvarką galite rasti apsilankę tinklalapyje www.canon-
europe.com/weee.

Samo za Evropsko unijo in EGP (Norveška, Islandija in Lihtenštajn)

Ta simbol pomeni, da tega izdelka v skladu z direktivo OEEO (2012/19/EU) in državno zakonodajo ne
smete odvreči v gospodinjske odpadke. Ta izdelek morate odložiti na ustrezno zbiralno mesto, na primer
pri pooblaščenem prodajalcu, ko kupite podoben nov izdelek ali na zbiralno mesto za recikliranje
električne in elektronske opreme. Neprimerno ravnanje s takšnimi odpadki lahko negativno vpliva na
okolje in človekovo zdravje zaradi nevarnih snovi, ki so povezane z električno in elektronsko opremo. S
pravilno odstranitvijo izdelka hkrati prispevate tudi k učinkoviti porabi naravnih virov. Če želite več
informacij o tem, kje lahko odložite odpadno opremo za recikliranje, pokličite občinski urad, komunalno
podjetje ali službo, ki skrbi za odstranjevanje odpadkov, ali si oglejte načrt OEEO. Če želite več informacij
o vračanju in recikliranju izdelkov v skladu z direktivo OEEO, obiščite www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Само за Европейския съюз и ЕИП (Норвегия, Исландия и


Лихтенщайн)

Този символ показва, че този продукт не трябва да се изхвърля заедно с битовите отпадъци,
съгласно Директивата за ИУЕЕО (2012/19/ЕC) и Вашето национално законодателство. Този
продукт трябва да бъде предаден в предназначен за целта пункт за събиране, например на база
размяна, когато купувате нов подобен продукт, или в одобрен събирателен пункт за рециклиране
на излязло от употреба електрическо и електронно оборудване (ИУЕЕО). Неправилното третиране
на този тип отпадъци може да доведе до евентуални отрицателни последствия за околната среда
и човешкото здраве поради потенциално опасните вещества, които обикновено са свързани с ЕЕО.
В същото време Вашето съдействие за правилното изхвърляне на този продукт ще допринесе за
ефективното използване на природните ресурси. Повече информация относно местата, където
може да предавате излязло от употреба оборудване за рециклиране, може да получите от
местните власти, от органа, отговорен за отпадъците и от одобрена система за излязло от
употреба ЕЕО или от Вашата местна служба за битови отпадъци. За повече информация относно
връщането и рециклирането на продукти от излязло от употреба ЕЕО посетете www.canon-
europe.com/weee.

140
Doar pentru Uniunea Europeană şi EEA (Norvegia, Islanda şi
Liechtenstein)

Acest simbol indică faptul că acest produs nu trebuie aruncat o dată cu reziduurile menajere, în
conformitate cu Directiva DEEE (Directiva privind deşeurile de echipamente electrice şi electronice)
(2012/19/UE) şi legile naţionale. Acest produs trebuie transportat la un punct de colectare special, de
exemplu un centru care preia produsele vechi atunci când achiziţionaţi un produs nou similar, sau la un
punct de colectare autorizat pentru reciclarea deşeurilor provenite de la echipamentele electrice şi
electronice (EEE). Mânuirea necorespunzătoare a acestor tipuri de deşeuri poate avea un impact negativ
asupra mediului înconjurător şi sănătăţii indivizilor, din cauza substanţelor potenţial nocive care sunt în
general asociate cu EEE. În acelaşi timp, cooperarea dvs. la reciclarea corectă a acestui produs va
contribui la utilizarea efectivă a resurselor naturale. Pentru mai multe informaţii privind locurile de reciclare
a deşeurilor provenite de la echipamente, contactaţi biroul primăriei locale, autoritatea responsabilă cu
colectarea deşeurilor, schema DEEE aprobată sau serviciul de colectare a deşeurilor menajere. Pentru
mai multe informaţii privind returnarea şi reciclarea produselor DEEE, vizitaţi www.canon-europe.com/
weee.

Samo za Europsku uniju i EEZ (Norveška, Island i Lihtenštajn)

Ovaj simbol pokazuje da se ovaj proizvod ne smije odlagati s kućnim otpadom sukladno WEEE Direktivi
(2012/19/EC) i vašem nacionalnom zakonu. Ovaj proizvod je potrebno predati na posebno mjesto za
sakupljanje otpada, npr. na ovlašteno mjesto gdje možete zamijeniti staro za novo ukoliko kupujete novi
sličan proizvod ili na ovlašteno mjesto za sakupljanje rabljene električne i elektroničke opreme (EEE) za
recikliranje. Nepropisno rukovanje ovom vrstom otpada može imati negativan učinak na okolinu i zdravlje
ljudi zbog supstanci koje su potencijalno opasne za zdravlje, a općenito se povezuju s EEE. Istovremeno,
vaša će suradnja kroz propisno odlaganje ovog proizvoda doprinijeti efektivnoj uporabi prirodnih resursa.
Za više informacija o tome gdje možete odložiti svoj otpad za recikliranje obratite se vašem lokalnom
gradskom uredu, komunalnoj službi, odobrenom WEEE programu ili službi za odlaganje kućnog otpada.
Ostale informacije o vraćanju i recikliranju WEEE proizvoda potražite na www.canon-europe.com/weee.

Korisnici u Srbiji

Ovaj simbol označava da ovaj proizvod ne sme da se odlaže sa ostalim kućnim otpadom, u skladu sa
WEEE Direktivom (2012/19/EU) i nacionalnim zakonima. Ovaj proizvod treba predati određenom centru
za prikupljanje, npr. na osnovi "jedan-za-jedan" kada kupujete sličan novi proizvod, ili ovlašćenom centru
za prikupljanje za reciklažu istrošene električne i elektronske opreme (EEE). Nepravilno rukovanje ovom

141
vrstom otpada može da ima moguće negativne posledice po životnu sredinu i ljudsko zdravlje usled
potencijalno opasnih materijala koji se uglavnom vezuju za EEE. U isto vreme, vaša saradnja na
ispravnom odlaganju ovog proizvoda će doprineti efikasnom korišćenju prirodnih resursa. Za više
informacija o tome gde možete da predate vašu staru opremu radi recikliranje, vas molimo, da
kontaktirate lokalne gradske vlasti, komunalne službe, odobreni plan reciklaže ili Gradsku čistoću. Za više
informacija o vraćanju i recikliranju WEEE proizvoda, posetite stranicu www.canon-europe.com/weee.

142
Handling Precautions

Canceling Print Jobs

Storing Printed Images

Legal Restrictions on Scanning/Copying

Transporting Your Printer

When Repairing, Lending, or Disposing of the Printer

Keeping Print Quality High

143
Legal Restrictions on Scanning/Copying

Scanning, printing, copying, or modifying copies of the following may be punishable under law.

This list is non-exhaustive. When in doubt, check with a local legal representative.

• Paper money

• Money orders

• Certificates of deposit

• Postage stamps (canceled or uncanceled)

• Identification badges or insignia

• Selective service or draft papers


• Checks or drafts issued by governmental agencies

• Motor vehicle licenses and certificates of title

• Traveler's checks

• Food stamps

• Passports

• Immigration papers

• Internal revenue stamps (canceled or uncanceled)

• Bonds or other certificates of indebtedness

• Stock certificates

• Copyrighted works or works of art, without the owner's consent

144
Transporting Your Printer

When relocating the printer for changing your living place or repairing it, make sure of the following.

Important
• Pack the printer in a sturdy box so that it is placed with its bottom facing down, using sufficient
protective material to ensure safe transport.

• With the FINE cartridge left installed in the printer, press the ON button to turn off the power. This
allows the printer to automatically cap the print head, thus preventing it from drying.

• After packing, do not tilt the box containing the printer or turn it on its side or upside down. Doing so
may cause the ink to leak during transport and cause damage to the printer.
• When a shipping agent is handling transport of the printer, have its box marked "THIS SIDE UP" to
keep the printer with its bottom facing down. Mark also with "FRAGILE" or "HANDLE WITH CARE".

1. Turn the printer off.

2. Check that ON lamp is off and unplug power cord.

Important
• Do not unplug the printer while the ON lamp is lit or flashing, as it may cause malfunction or
damage to the printer, making the printer unable to print.

3. Retract the paper output support with the output tray extension closed.

4. Close the front cover.

5. Unplug the printer cable from the computer and from the printer, then unplug the power
cord from the printer.

6. Use adhesive tape to secure all the covers on the printer to keep them from opening during
transportation. Then pack the printer in the plastic bag.

7. Attach the protective material to the printer when packing the printer in the box.

145
Important
• We recommend to hold and carry out this printer as shown in the figure below. If you hold the front
cover or the cassette, it may fall out of the printer.

146
When Repairing, Lending, or Disposing of the Printer

If you have entered personal data, passwords and/or other security settings on the printer, such information
may be stored in the printer.

When sending the printer for repair, lending or transferring the printer to another person, or disposing of the
printer, please be sure to follow the steps below in order to delete such information and prevent third parties
from accessing it.

Press the Setup button and select Device settings > Reset setting > All data. Next, press the OK button
and select Yes.

For printers with fax capabilities, user information and speed dial numbers can be backed up to a computer
by utilizing the Speed Dial Utility2 software before resetting the printer or deleting data. Backed up data can
be restored to the repaired printer or another Canon printer.

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)


Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS)

147
Keeping Print Quality High

The key to printing with the optimal printing quality is to prevent the print head from drying or clogging.
Always observe the following rules for optimal printing quality.

Note
• Depending on the type of paper, ink may blur if you trace the printed area with a highlight pen or paint-
stick, or bleed if water or sweat comes in contact with the printed area.

Never unplug the power cord until the power is turned off!
If you press the ON button to turn off the power, the printer caps the print head (nozzles) automatically to
prevent from drying. If you unplug the power cord from the wall outlet before the ON lamp is turned off, the
print head will not be capped properly and this will cause drying or clogging.

When unplugging the power cord, check that the ON lamp is not lit.

Important
• If the power cord is unplugged, the date/time settings will be reset and all documents stored in the
printer's memory will be lost. Send or print a necessary document before unplugging the power cord.

Print periodically!
Just as the tip of a felt pen becomes dry and unusable if it has not been used for a long time, even if it is
capped, the print head too, may become dried or clogged if the printer has not been used for a long time.
We recommend you to use the printer at least once a month.

148
Main Components and Their Use

Main Components

Power Supply

LCD and Operation Panel

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

149
Main Components

Front View

Rear View

Inside View

Operation Panel

150
Front View

A: Operation Panel
Use to change the settings of the printer or to operate it.

Operation Panel

B: Platen
Load an original here.

C: Document Cover
Open to load an original on the platen.

D: Paper Guides
Align with both sides of the paper stack.

E: Cassette
Load paper here. Two or more sheets of the same size and type of paper can be loaded at the same
time, and fed automatically one sheet at a time.

Loading Plain Paper


Loading Photo Paper
Loading Envelopes

F: Paper Output Tray


Printed paper is ejected.

G: Paper Output Support


Extend to support ejected paper.

H: Output Tray Extension


Open to support ejected paper.

151
I: Paper Output Cover
Open to replace the FINE cartridge or remove jammed paper inside the printer.

J: ON button
Turns the power on or off. Before turning on the power, make sure that the document cover is closed.

Turning the Printer On and Off

K: ON lamp
Lights after flashing when the power is turned on.

L: FAX Memory lamp


Lights when there are received or unsent documents stored in the printer's memory.

M: Alarm lamp
Lights or flashes when an error occurs.

N: ADF (Auto Document Feeder)


Load a document here. The documents loaded in the document tray are scanned automatically one
sheet at a time.
Loading Documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

O: Document Feeder Cover


Open when clearing jammed documents.

P: Document Guide
Adjust this guide to match the width of document in the ADF.

Q: Document Tray
Open to load a document in the ADF. You can load two or more sheets of document of the same size
and thickness. Load the document with the side you want to scan facing up.

R: Document Output Slot


Documents scanned from the ADF are delivered here.

S: Front Cover
Open to load paper in the cassette.

152
Rear View

A: Power Cord Connector


Plug in the supplied power cord.

B: Rear Cover
Open when removing jammed paper.

C: Telephone Line Jack


Connect the telephone line.

D: External Device Jack


Connect an external device such as telephone or answering device.

E: USB Port
Plug in the USB cable to connect the printer with a computer.

F: Transport Unit Cover


Detach when removing jammed paper.

Important
• Do not touch the metal casing.

• Do not plug in or unplug the USB cable while the printer is printing or scanning with the computer. This
can cause trouble.

153
Inside View

A: FINE Cartridge (ink cartridges)


A replaceable cartridge that integrates print head and ink tank.

B: FINE Cartridge Holder


Install the FINE cartridge.

The color FINE cartridge should be installed into the left slot and the black FINE cartridge should be
installed into the right slot.

Note
• For details on replacing a FINE cartridge, see Replacing a FINE Cartridge.

Important
• The area around the parts C may be splattered with ink. This does not affect the performance of the
printer.

• Do not touch the parts C. The printer may not print properly if you touch them.

154
Operation Panel

A: LCD (Liquid Crystal Display)


Displays messages, menu items, and the operational status.

B: Back button
Returns the LCD to the previous screen.

C: FAX button
Switches the printer to the fax mode.

D: COPY button
Switches the printer to the copy mode.

E: SCAN button
Switches the printer to the scan mode.

F: Setup button
Displays the Setup menu screen. With this menu, you can perform printer maintenance and change
printer settings.

G: Black button
Starts black & white copying, scanning, faxing, etc.

H: Color button
Starts color copying, scanning, faxing, etc.

I: and buttons
Used to select a menu or setting item. The button is also used when entering characters.

Selecting a Menu or Setting Item

155
J: OK button
Finalizes the selection of a menu or setting item. This button is also used to resolve an error or ejects
documents in the ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

K: Menu/Wireless connect button


Displays the Copy menu, Scan menu, or FAX menu screen.

To set wireless router information in the printer directly from a smartphone or other such device (without
having to do any procedures at the router), hold down this button.

L: Numeric buttons
Used to enter numerical values such as the number of copies, as well as fax/telephone numbers and
characters.

M: Tone button
Switches to tone dialing temporarily if your printer is connected to a rotary pulse line.
N: Stop button
Cancels operation when print, copy, scan, or fax transmission/reception job is in progress.

Note
• The printer makes the beep sound when pressing keypad buttons on the operation panel. The keypad
sound can be enabled or disabled in Sound control of Other dev. settings.

Other dev. settings

156
Power Supply

Checking that Power Is On

Turning the Printer On and Off

Checking the Power Plug/Power Cord

Unplugging the Printer

157
Checking that Power Is On

The ON lamp is lit when the printer is turned on.

Even if the LCD is off, if the ON lamp is lit, the printer is on.

Note
• It may take a while for the printer to start printing immediately after you turn on the printer.

• The LCD will turn off if the printer is not operated for about 10 minutes. To restore the display, press
any button or perform the print operation. The display will be also restored when receiving faxes. You
cannot change the wait time before the LCD turns off.

158
Turning the Printer On and Off

Turning on the printer

1. Press the ON button to turn on the printer.


The ON lamp flashes and then remains lit.
Confirming that the Power Is On

Note
• It may take a while for the printer to start printing immediately after you turn on the printer.

• If an error message is displayed on the LCD, see An Error Occurs.

• You can set the printer to automatically turn on when a print or scan operation is performed
from a computer connected by USB cable or wireless network. This feature is set to off by
default.

From the printer

ECO settings

From the computer

• For Windows:
Managing the Printer Power

• For macOS:
Managing the Printer Power

Turning off the printer

1. Press the ON button to turn off the printer.


When the ON lamp stops flashing, the printer is turned off.

159
Important
• When you unplug the power cord after turning off the printer, be sure to confirm that the ON
lamp is off.

Note
• You can set the printer to automatically turn off when no operations are performed or no print
jobs are sent to the printer for a certain interval. This feature is set to on by default.
From the printer

ECO settings

From the computer


• For Windows:

Managing the Printer Power


• For macOS:

Managing the Printer Power

160
Checking the Power Plug/Power Cord

Check the power plug/power cord once a month to confirm that it does not have anything unusual described
below.

• The power plug/power cord is hot.

• The power plug/power cord is rusty.

• The power plug/power cord is bent.

• The power plug/power cord is worn.

• The power plug/power cord is split.

Caution
• If you find anything unusual with the power plug/power cord described above, unplug the power cord
and call for service. Using the printer with one of the unusual conditions above may cause a fire or an
electric shock.

161
Unplugging the Printer

To unplug the power cord, follow the procedure below.

Important
• When you unplug the power cord, press the ON button, then confirm that the ON lamp is off.
Unplugging the power cord while the ON lamp is lit or flashing may cause drying or clogging of the print
head and print quality may be reduced.

• If the power cord is unplugged, the date/time settings will be reset and all documents stored in the
printer's memory will be lost. Send or print a necessary document before unplugging the power cord.

1. Press the ON button to turn the printer off.

2. Confirm that the ON lamp is off.

3. Unplug the power cord.

The specification of the power cord differs depending on the country or region of use.

162
LCD and Operation Panel

The mode button (A) on the operation panel allows you to switch between the copy mode, scan mode, fax
mode, and setup menu screen.

Pressing the Menu/Wireless connect button (B) in the respective modes shows the menu screen to select
various functions or settings.

Selecting a Menu or Setting Item


On the menu screen or settings screen, use the button (C) to select an item or option, then press
the OK button (D) to proceed with the procedure.

To return to the previous screen, press the Back button (E).

Example: Changing the scan contrast for faxing.

1. Press Menu/Wireless connect button in Fax standby screen.

2. Press the button (C) to select FAX TX settings.

3. Press the OK button (D).

163
4. Select Scan contrast, press the OK button (D).

5. Use the button (C) to change the contrast, then press the OK button (D).

Network Status Indication


Wi-Fi setting and the network status indicate by the icon.

If the icon appears on the LCD when the SCAN button or Setup button is pressed, it indicates
that Wi-Fi is enabled and the printer is connected to the wireless router.

Depending on the signal state, the icon will change.

Signal strength: 81 % or more

You can use the printer over Wi-Fi without any problems.

Signal strength: 51 % or more

The problem such as the printer cannot print may occur according to the network sta-
tus. We recommend placing the printer near the wireless router.

Signal strength: 50 % or less

The problem such as the printer cannot print may occur. Place the printer near the
wireless router.

Wi-Fi is enabled but the printer is not connected to the wireless router.

Note

• When Wi-Fi is disabled, icon is not displayed.

164
Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

Use the Numeric buttons to enter or edit such information as unit name, a recipient's name for the directory,
etc.

Switching the Input Mode


Each time the Tone button is pressed, the input mode is switched.

The current input mode appears at the upper right corner of the LCD.

Note
• Only numbers and symbols that are available for the type of information you are entering are
displayed, such as numbers for telephone or fax number input.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

Press the Tone button to switch the input mode.

Use the Numeric buttons to enter the desired characters.

• To insert a space

Press the button five times.

• To delete the last entered character

Press the Back button.

Editing Entered Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

Press the or button to move the cursor under the position you want to edit.

• To insert a space

Press the button five times.

• To insert a character

Move the cursor under the character to the right of the insertion position, then enter the character. The
character on the cursor will move to the right and the new character will be inserted.

• To delete a character

Move the cursor under the character, then press the Back button.

165
List of Characters Assigned to Each Numeric Button

For Fax/Telephone Number, Name, Number of Copies


Lowercase mode Uppercase mode Numeric mode Fax/Tele-
Button
(:a) (:A) (:1) phone no.

1 1

abcåäáàãâæç ABCÅÄÁÀÃÂÆÇ 2 2

defëéèê DEFËÉÈÊ 3 3

gh i ï í ì î GH I Ï Í Ì Î 4 4

jkl JKL 5 5

mnoñøöóòõô MNOÑØÖÓÒÕÔ 6 6

pqrsþ PQRSÞ 7 7

tuvüúùû TUVÜÚÙÛ 8 8

wxyzý WXYZÝ 9 9

0 0

. @ - _ SP*1 #!",;:^`=/|'?$%&+()[]{}<> #

Switch the input mode.

*1 "SP" indicates a space.

For LAN Settings


Lowercase mode Uppercase mode Numeric mode
Button
(:a) (:A) (:1)

abc ABC 2

def DEF 3

gh i GH I 4

jkl JKL 5

mno MNO 6

166
pqrs PQRS 7

tuv TUV 8

wxyz WXYZ 9

. @ - _ SP*2 #!",;:^`=/|'?$%&+()[]{}<>\~

Switch the input mode.

*2 "SP" indicates a space.

167
Changing Settings

Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (Windows)

Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (macOS)

Changing Settings from Operation Panel

168
Changing Printer Settings from Your Computer (macOS)

Managing the Printer Power

Changing the Printer Operation Mode

169
Managing the Printer Power

Printer power supply is operated from Remote UI.

Energy saving settings


Energy saving settings allow you to set Auto power off and Auto power on.

Auto power off is the function wherein the printer automatically turns itself off, when data is not sent or
the printer remains inactive for a certain period.
The Auto power on function automatically turns on the printer when data is received.

1. Selecting Device settings from Remote UI

2. Click Energy saving settings

3. Complete the following settings:


Auto power off
Specify the time from the list. Printer automatically turns itself off, when data is not sent within the
specified time or the printer has remained inactive.

Auto power on
When you check this check box, the printer automatically turns itself on when data is sent.

4. Apply the settings


Click OK.
The printer will operate with the changed settings hereafter.

170
Changing the Printer Operation Mode

If necessary, switch between various modes of printer operation.

1. Check whether the printer is on and select Device settings from Remote UI

2. If necessary, complete the following settings:


Print settings - Prevent paper abrasion
The printer can increase the gap between the print head and the paper during high-density printing
to prevent paper abrasion.
Check this check box to prevent paper abrasion.
Custom settings - Detect paper setting mismatch
If the check box is deselected, at the time of printing from PC, you can continue to print without the
message display even if the paper settings set in the Print dialog differs from the paper information
registered to the printer.
Ink drying wait time
You can set the length of the printer rest time until printing of the next page begins. The wait time
becomes longer as the value set in the list increases, and shorter as the value decreases.
If the paper gets stained because the next page is ejected before the ink on the printed page dries,
increase the ink drying wait time.
Reducing the ink drying wait time speeds up printing.

3. Apply the settings


Click OK.

The printer operates with the modified settings hereafter.

171
Changing Settings from Operation Panel

Changing Settings from Operation Panel

Setting Items on Operation Panel

FAX settings

Print settings

LAN settings

Other dev. settings

Language selection

Firmware update

Reset setting

Feed settings

Web service setup

ECO settings

Quiet setting

System information

172
Changing Settings from Operation Panel

This section describes the procedure to change the settings in the Device settings screen, taking the steps
to specify Extended copy amt. as an example.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.


The Device settings screen is displayed.

4. Select a setting item to adjust and then press the OK button.

The setting screen for the selected item is displayed.

5. Select a setting item and then press the OK button.

6. Select a setting to specify and then press the OK button.

For more on setting items on the operation panel:

Setting Items on Operation Panel

173
Setting Items on Operation Panel

Items for Printer


FAX settings
Other dev. settings
Language selection
Web service setup
ECO settings
Quiet setting

Items for Paper/Printing


Print settings
Feed settings

Items for Maintenance/Management


LAN settings
Firmware update
Reset setting
System information

174
FAX settings

Select this menu from Setup menu.

Easy setup
TEL no. registration
FAX user settings
Adv. FAX settings
Auto print settings
Security control

Note
• Before changing the settings, you can confirm the current settings by printing USER'S DATA LIST.
Summary of Reports and Lists

Easy setup
The printer must be set up depending on your telephone line and use of the faxing function. Follow the
procedure according to the instructions on the LCD.

Note
• You can specify the setup setting individually or the advanced setting.

For details on how to specify the setting:

Preparing for Faxing

TEL no. registration


You can register the recipient's fax/telephone number to the printer.
Registering Recipients Using Operation Panel of Printer

FAX user settings

• Unit TEL no. registr.

Registers your fax/telephone number printed on sent faxes.

Registering User Information

• Unit name registr.

Registers your name printed on sent faxes.

Registering User Information

• Telephone line type (Country or region of purchase other than China)

Selects the telephone line type setting for the printer.

Setting Telephone Line Type

175
Note
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• TEL line auto select (China only)


If you select ON, the telephone line type is selected automatically.

If you select OFF, you can select the telephone line type manually.

Setting Telephone Line Type

Adv. FAX settings

• Err reduction (VoIP)


If you select Reduce, it may be possible to reduce the incidence of communication errors when
connecting to internet line such as IP phone.

Note
• When Reduce is selected, V.34 (Super G3) cannot be used. Communication time generally
becomes longer than when communicating with V.34 (super G3).

• This setting has priority even if you select 33600 bps for TX start speed or RX start speed.

• Auto redial

Enables/disables automatic redialing.

If you select ON, you can specify the maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the
printer waits between redial attempts.

• Dial tone detect

Avoids mistransmission when reception and transmission occur at the same time.

If you select ON, the printer transmits the fax after confirming the dial tone.

Note
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• Pause time settings


Sets the length of pause time for each when you enter "P" (pause).

• TTI position
Selects the position of the sender information (outside or inside the image area).

• Remote RX
Enables/disables remote reception.

If you select ON, you can specify the remote reception ID.

Remote Reception

176
• Color transmission
When faxing color documents using the ADF (Auto Document Feeder), selects whether to convert
them into black & white data if the recipient's fax device does not support color faxing.

If you select If incompatible, end, the printer does not send color documents when the recipient's fax
device does not support color faxing.

If you select If incompat., B&W, the printer send documents in black & white when the recipient's fax
device does not support color faxing.

• RX image reduction

Enables/disables automatic reduction of incoming faxes so that they fit in the selected paper.

If you select ON, you can select the image reduction direction.

• Adv. communication

◦ ECM TX

Selects whether to send faxes in Error Correction Mode (ECM).

Transmission/Reception of Faxes Using ECM


◦ ECM RX

Selects whether to receive faxes in Error Correction Mode (ECM).

Transmission/Reception of Faxes Using ECM


◦ TX start speed

Selects the fax transmission speed.

Ex:

The following settings are available.


33600 bps/14400 bps/9600 bps/4800 bps

The fax transmission start speed will be faster as the value is bigger.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

• Some of settings are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• When the telephone line condition or connection is poor, selecting a lower transmission start
speed may solve transmission problems.

◦ RX start speed

Selects the fax reception speed.

Ex:

The following settings are available.

177
33600 bps/14400 bps/9600 bps/4800 bps
The fax reception start speed will be faster as the value is bigger.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

• Some of settings are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• When the telephone line condition or connection is poor, selecting a lower reception start
speed may solve reception problems.

Auto print settings

• Received documents

Selects whether to print the received fax automatically when receiving a fax.

If you select Do not print, the received fax is stored in the printer's memory.

For details on the received fax stored in the printer's memory:

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

• Activity report

Selects whether to print ACTIVITY REPORT automatically.

If you select Print, the printer prints ACTIVITY REPORT for the 20 histories of sent and received
faxes automatically.

For details on the procedure to print ACTIVITY REPORT manually:

Summary of Reports and Lists

• TX report

Selects whether to print TX REPORT/ERROR TX REPORT automatically after sending a fax.


If you print the report, select Print error only or Print for each TX.

If you select Print error only or Print for each TX, you can specify the print setting that the first page
of the fax is printed along with the report.

• RX report
Selects whether to print RX REPORT automatically after receiving a fax.

If you print RX REPORT, select Print error only or Print for each RX.

• Print when no ink


Sets whether to continue printing the received fax without storing it in the printer's memory when the
ink has run out.

However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.

178
Security control

• FAX no. re-entry


If you select ON, you can set the printer to send faxes after using the Numeric buttons to enter the
number twice. By using this setting, you can avoid the mistransmission of faxes.

Preventing Mistransmission of Faxes

• Check RX FAX info

If you select ON, the printer checks whether the recipient's fax device information matches the dialed
number. If it matches the number, the printer starts to send faxes.

Preventing Mistransmission of Faxes

• Hook setting

If you select Enable, you can use the on hook dial function.

• FAX RX reject

If you select ON, the printer rejects the reception of faxes with no sender information or faxes from
specific senders.

Rejecting Fax Reception

• Caller rejection

If you subscribe to the Caller ID service, the printer detects the sender's Caller ID. If the sender's ID
matches the condition specified in this setting, the printer rejects the phone call or fax reception from
the sender.

If you select Subscribed, you can specify the settings of rejection.

Using Caller ID Service to Reject Calls

Note
• This setting may not be supported depending on the country or region of purchase. Contact your
telephone company to confirm whether it provides this service.

179
Print settings

Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.

• Prevent abrasion
Use this setting only if the print surface becomes smudged.

Important
• Be sure to set this back to OFF after printing since it may result in lower printing speed or lower
print quality.

• Extended copy amt.


Selects the amount of image that extends off the paper when copying in Borderless (full).

Slight cropping may occur at the edges since the copied image is enlarged to fill the whole page. You
can change the width to be cropped from the borders of the original image as needed.

Cropped area will be larger if Amount: Large is selected.

Note
• If printouts contain margins even though you are copying in Borderless, specifying Amount: Large
for this setting may help solve the problem.

• Prevent double-feed

Select ON to prevent double-feed of plain paper.

Important
• Be sure to set this back to OFF after printing since it may result in lower printing speed.

180
LAN settings

Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.

Wi-Fi
Wireless Direct
Print LAN details

Wi-Fi

• Enable/disab. Wi-Fi

Enables or disables Wi-Fi.

• Wi-Fi setup

Selects the setup method for Wi-Fi connection.

Note
• You can also enter this setting menu by selecting Wi-Fi setup from the Setup menu screen.

◦ Easy Wi-Fi connect

Select if you specify the settings of the access point information to the printer directly from a
device (such as a smartphone) without operating the wireless router. Follow the on-screen
instructions of the connecting device for the setup procedure.

◦ Manual connect

Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi manually using the operation panel of the printer.

◦ WPS (Push button)

Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi using a wireless router supporting a Wi-Fi Protected
Setup (WPS) push button method. Follow the on-screen instructions during setup.

◦ Other setup
■ Manual setup

Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi manually. You can specify multiple WEP keys.
■ WPS (PIN code)
Select when you perform settings for Wi-Fi using a wireless router supporting a Wi-Fi
Protected Setup (WPS) PIN code method. Follow the on-screen instructions during setup.

• Manual setup
For details on each setting item:

Manual setup

Wireless Direct

• Switch WL Direct

Enables/disables Wireless Direct.

181
• Change name (SSID)
Changes the identifier (SSID/the printer's name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device) for
Wireless Direct.

• Change password
Changes the password for Wireless Direct.

• Confirm request
Set whether the printer displays the confirmation screen when a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is
connecting the printer.

• Manual setup

For details on each setting item:


Manual setup

Print LAN details


You can print out the network settings of the printer such as its IP address and SSID.

For more information on the printer's network setting is printed out:

Printing Network Settings

Important
• The network settings printout contains important information about your network. Handle it with care.

Manual setup

• Set printer name

Specifies the printer name. You can use up to 15 characters for the name.

Note
• You cannot use the same printer name as that already used for other LAN connected devices.

• You cannot use a hyphen for the initial or last character of the printer name.

• TCP/IP settings

Performs IPv4 or IPv6 setting.


• WSD setting

Setting items when you use WSD (one of the network protocols supported in Windows).

Enable/disable WSD
Selects whether WSD is enabled or disabled.

Note
• When this setting is enabled, the printer icon is displayed on the Network Explorer in Windows.

182
Optimize WSD-In
Selecting Active allows you to receive the WSD printing data faster.

WSD scan from dev.


Selecting Active allows you to transfer the scanned data to the computer using WSD.

Timeout setting
Specifies the timeout length.

• Bonjour settings
Setting items for LAN using Bonjour for macOS.

Enab./disab. Bonjour
Selecting Active allows you to use Bonjour to perform the network settings.

Enter service name


Specifies the Bonjour service name. You can use up to 48 characters for the name.

Note
• You cannot use the same service name as that already used for other LAN connected devices.

• LPR setting

Enables/disables the LPR setting.


• RAW protocol

Enables/disables RAW printing.


• LLMNR

Enables/disables LLMNR (Link-Local Multicast Name Resolution). Selecting Active allows the printer
to detect printer's IP address from the printer name without a DNS server.
• IPP settings

Selecting Active allows you to print via the network with the IPP protocol.
• IPsec settings

Selecting Active allows you to specify the IPsec settings.

183
Other dev. settings

Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.

• Date/time setting
Sets the current date and time.

Setting Sender Information

Important
• If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, the date/time settings will be reset.

• Date display format


Sets the format of dates displayed on the LCD and printed on sent faxes.

• DST setting

Some countries adopt the daylight saving time (summer time) system that shifts the clock time forward
at certain periods of the year.

You can set your printer to automatically change the time by registering the date and time that daylight
saving time (summer time) begins and ends.

Setting Sender Information

Note
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• Sound control

Selects whether the beep sound in operations is enabled or not.


◦ Keypad sound

Selects whether the beep sound is enabled or not when pressing the buttons on the operation
panel.
◦ Alarm sound

Selects whether the alarm is enabled or not.


◦ Line monitor sound

Selects whether the line monitor sound is enabled or not.

◦ Offhook alarm

Selects whether the alarm is enabled or not when the phone receiver is not put on the hook
properly.

• Country or region

Selects the country or region where you are using the printer.

Note
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

184
• Key repeat
Enables/Disables continuous input by pressing and holding down the button when setting the
number of copies, the zoom ratio, etc.

• Doc. remov. reminder


Selects whether the printer will display the reminder screen in case you forget to remove the original
from the platen after scanning.

Important
• Depending on the type of original or the state of the document cover, forgetting to remove the
original may not be detected.

185
Language selection

Changes the language for LCD messages and menus.

Japanese / English / German / French / Italian / Spanish / Dutch / Portuguese / Norwegian / Swedish /
Danish / Finnish / Russian / Ukrainian / Polish / Czech / Slovak / Hungarian / Slovene / Croatian /
Romanian / Bulgarian / Turkish / Greek / Estonian / Latvian / Lithuanian / Simplified Chinese / Traditional
Chinese / Korean / Indonesian / Vietnamese

186
Firmware update

Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.

You can update the firmware of the printer, check the firmware version, or perform settings of a notification
screen.

Important
• When you use this function, make sure the printer is connected to the internet.

Note
• Only Current version is available when Inactive is selected for Enable/disab. Wi-Fi in Wi-Fi under
LAN settings.

• Install update

Performs the firmware update of the printer. Follow the on-screen instructions to perform update.

Note
• If the firmware update is not complete, check the following and take an appropriate action.

• Check the network settings such as a wireless router.

• If Cannot connect to the server; try again is displayed on the LCD, press the OK button and
try again after a while.

• Current version

You can check the current firmware version.

• Update notification

When ON is selected and the firmware update is available, the screen to inform you of the firmware
update is displayed on the LCD.

• DNS server setup

Performs settings for a DNS server. Select Auto setup or Manual setup. If you select Manual setup,
follow the display on the LCD to perform settings.

• Proxy server setup

Performs settings for a proxy server. Select Use or Do not use. If you select Use, follow the display on
the LCD to perform settings.

187
Reset setting

Select this menu from Device settings in Setup menu.

Returns all settings you made to the printer back to the default. However, some data may not be changed,
depending on the current usage state of your printer.

Important
• Depending on the setting item, it is necessary to perform connection or setup again after you have
returned the setting back to the default.

• Web service setup

Returns the Web service settings back to the default.

• LAN settings

Returns the LAN settings back to the default.

• Telephone no. data

Returns the telephone/fax number settings to default.

• Setting data

Returns the settings such as the paper size, media type, or other setting items other than the LAN
settings or the fax settings back to the default.

• FAX settings

Returns the fax settings back to the default. Disconnect the telephone line from the printer before you
return this setting item back to the default.

After resetting, perform setup again as necessary.

• All data

Sets all settings you made to the printer back to the default. The administrator password specified by
Remote UI or IJ Network Device Setup Utility reverts to the default setting.

After resetting, perform setup again as necessary.

Note
• You cannot set the following setting items back to the default:

• The language displayed on the LCD

• The current position of the print head

• CSR (Certificate Signing Request) for encryption method (SSL/TLS) setting

• The country or region selected for Country or region

You can delete the registered user's name or telephone number following the procedure below.

1. Displays Unit TEL no. registr. or Displays Unit name registr..

Setting Sender Information

2. Delete all the numbers and the letters by pressing the Back button.

188
3. Press the OK button after deleting all the numbers and the letters.

189
Feed settings

Select this menu from Setup menu.

By registering the paper size and the media type loaded in the cassette, you can prevent the printer from
misprinting by displaying the message before printing starts when the paper size or the media type of the
loaded paper differs from the print settings.

For details:

Paper Settings

• Save paper info

Saves the paper size and the media type you load in the cassette.

Note
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver
(Windows) or on the LCD:

Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)

• Det. paper mismatch

If you select ON, the printer detects whether the paper size and the media type are identical with those
registered in Save paper info. If printing starts with the settings that do not match, an error message is
displayed on the LCD.

Note
• When OFF is selected, Detect reinsertion is disabled.

• Detect reinsertion

If you select ON, the printer detects the cassette is reinserted. When the Save paper info screen is
displayed, register the paper size and the media type.

190
Web service setup

Select this menu from Setup menu.

• Connection setup
The following setting items are available.

◦ GoogleCloudPrint
Registers/Deletes the printer to/from Google Cloud Print.

• DNS server setup

Performs settings for a DNS server. Select Auto setup or Manual setup. If you select Manual setup,
follow the display on the LCD to perform settings.

• Proxy server setup

Performs settings for a proxy server. Select Use or Do not use. If you select Use, follow the display on
the LCD to perform settings.

191
ECO settings

This setting allows you to turn on/off the printer automatically to save electricity.

Turning off Printer Automatically


Turning on Printer Automatically
Using Two-sided Printing

Turning off Printer Automatically


You can enable the printer to turn off automatically when no operation is made or no printing data is sent
to the printer for a specified period of time.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.

4. Select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.

5. Select Auto power off and then press the OK button.

6. Select a time to turn off the printer and then press the OK button.

Turning on Printer Automatically


You can enable the printer to turn on automatically when printing data is sent to the printer or the printer is
operated for scanning from the computer.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.

4. Select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.

5. Select Auto power on and then press the OK button.

6. Select ON and then press the OK button.

192
Using Two-sided Printing
Follow the procedure below to use duplex printing.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select ECO settings and then press the OK button.

4. Select 2-sidedPrintSetting and then press the OK button.

5. Specify settings as necessary.


• Copy
Select two-sided copying as a default.
• Template print

Select two-sided printing of template forms on the printer as a default.


• FAX print

Select two-sided printing of sent/received faxes, reports, or lists as a default.

193
Quiet setting

Enables this function on the printer if you want to reduce the operating noise, such as when printing at night.
In addition, you can specify the time range to reduce the operating noise.

Important
• Set the current date and time in advance.
Setting Sender Information

Follow the procedure below to perform setting.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Quiet mode and then press the OK button.

4. Select Use or Specify hrs of use and then press the OK button.
• When Use is selected:

You can reduce the operating noise while printing is in progress.

• When Specify hrs of use is selected:

The screen to specify starting/ending time is displayed. Use the button to move the cursor
under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to enter the time, then press the OK button.

You can reduce the operating noise during the specified time.

Important
• Operating speed may be reduced compared to when Do not use is selected.
• This function may not be so effective depending on the printer's setting. Furthermore, certain
noise, such as when the printer is preparing for printing, is not reduced.

Note
• You can set the quiet mode from the operation panel of the printer, the printer driver, or ScanGear
(scanner driver). No matter how you set the quiet mode, the mode is applied when you perform
operations from the operation panel of the printer or printing and scanning from the computer.

194
System information

Select this menu from Setup menu.

• Current version
Displays the current firmware version.

• Printer name
Displays the printer name currently specified.

• Serial number

Displays the printer serial number.

195
Specifications

General Specifications
Printing resolution (dpi) 4800* (horizontal) x 1200 (vertical)

* Ink droplets can be placed with a pitch of 1/4800 inch at minimum.

Interface USB Port:

Hi-Speed USB *

LAN Port:

Wi-Fi: IEEE802.11n / IEEE802.11g / IEEE802.11b

* A computer that complies with Hi-Speed USB standard is required. Since the
Hi-Speed USB interface is fully upwardly compatible with USB 1.1, it can be
used at USB 1.1.

USB and LAN can be used at the same time.

Print width 8 inches/203.2 mm

(for Borderless Printing: 8.5 inches/216 mm)

Printable area Borderless printing: Top/Bottom/Left/Right margin: 0.0 inch (0.0 mm)

Standard printing:
• Top margin:

◦ 0.12 inch (3.0 mm)

• Bottom margin:

◦ 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)

• Left margin:

◦ Letter/Legal: 0.26 inch (6.4 mm)

◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)

• Right margin:

◦ Letter/Legal: 0.25 inch (6.3 mm)

◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)

* For printable area of envelope, see below.

Envelopes

Auto duplex printing:

• Top margin: 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)

• Bottom margin: 0.20 inch (5.0 mm)

• Left margin:

◦ Letter: 0.26 inch (6.4 mm)

◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)

• Right margin:

◦ Letter: 0.25 inch (6.3 mm)

196
◦ Other sizes: 0.14 inch (3.4 mm)

Operating environment Temperature: 41 to 95 °F (5 to 35 °C)

Humidity: 10 to 90 % RH (no condensation)

* The performance of the printer may be reduced under certain temperature


and humidity conditions.

Recommended conditions:

Temperature: 59 to 86 °F (15 to 30 °C)

Humidity: 10 to 80 % RH (no condensation)

* For the temperature and humidity conditions of papers such as photo paper,
refer to the paper's packaging or the supplied instructions.

Storage environment Temperature: 32 to 104 °F (0 to 40 °C)

Humidity: 5 to 95 % RH (no condensation)

Power supply AC 100-240 V, 50/60 Hz

(The supplied power cord is only for the country or region you purchased.)

Power consumption Printing (Copy): 8 W or less *1

Standby (minimum): 0.9 W or less *1*2

OFF: 0.2 W or less

*1 USB connection to PC

*2 The wait time for standby cannot be changed.

External dimensions Approx. 17.2 (W) x 11.7 (D) x 7.5 (H) inches

Approx. 435 (W) x 295 (D) x 189 (H) mm

* With the Cassette and trays retracted.

Weight Approx. 13.0 lb (Approx. 5.9 kg)

* With the FINE Cartridges installed.

Canon FINE Cartridge Total 1280 nozzles (BK 320 nozzles, C/M/Y each 320 nozzles)

ADF capacity A4 or Letter size: max. 20 sheets (20 lb/75 g /m2 paper), up to 0.08 inch/2 mm
in height

Legal size: max. 5 sheets (20 lb/75 g /m2 paper), up to 0.02 inch/0.5 mm in
height

Copy Specifications
Multiple copy max. 99 pages

Intensity adjustment 9 positions, Auto intensity (AE copy)

Reduction / Enlargement 25 % - 400 % (1 % unit)

197
Scan Specifications
Scanner driver Windows: TWAIN 1.9 Specification, WIA

Maximum scanning size Platen: A4/Letter, 8.5" x 11.7"/216 x 297 mm

ADF: A4/Letter/Legal, 8.5" x 14.0"/216 x 356 mm

Optical resolution (horizontal x 600 x 1200 dpi *


vertical) * Optical Resolution represents the maximum sampling rate based on ISO
14473.

Gradation (Input / Output) Gray: 16 bit/8 bit

Color: RGB each 16 bit/8 bit

Fax Specifications
Applicable line Public Switched Telephone Network (PSTN)

IP phone line (IP phone line with quality of no problem at all by using in conver-
sation)

Communication mode Super G3, G3

Data compressing system Black: MH, MR, MMR

Color: JPEG

Modem speed max. 33.6 kbps

(Automatic fallback)

Transmission speed Black: Approx. 3 seconds/page at 33.6 kbps

(Based on ITU-T No.1 chart for US specifications and Canon FAX Standard
chart No.1 for others, both in standard mode.)

Color: Approx. 1 minute/page at 33.6 kbps

(Based on Canon COLOR FAX TEST SHEET.)

Gradation Black: 256 levels

Color: 24 bit Full Color (RGB each 8 bit)

Density adjustment 3 levels

Memory Transmission/reception: approx. 50 pages

(Based on ITU-T No.1 chart for US specifications and Canon FAX Standard
chart No.1 for others, both in standard mode.)

Fax resolution Black Standard: 203 pels/inch x 98 lines/inch (8 pels/mm x 3.85 lines/mm)

Black Fine, Photo: 203 pels/inch x 196 lines/inch (8 pels/mm x 7.70 lines/mm)

Black Extra fine: 300 x 300 dpi

Color: 200 x 200 dpi

Dialing Automatic dialing

198
• Recipient (max. 20 destinations)

• Group dial (max. 19 destinations)

Regular dialing (with Numeric buttons)

Automatic redialing

Manual redialing (max. 10 destinations)

Others Activity report (after every 20 transactions)

Sequential broadcasting (max. 21 destinations)

Rejected numbers (max. 10 destinations)

Err reduction (VoIP) *

* For details, see "Err reduction (VoIP)" in "Adv. FAX settings".

Network Specifications
Communication protocol TCP/IP

Wi-Fi Supported Standards: IEEE802.11n / IEEE802.11g / IEEE802.11b

Frequency bandwidth: 2.4 GHz

Channel: 1-11 or 1-13

* Frequency bandwidth and available channels differ depending on country or


region.

Communication distance: Indoors 164 feet/50 m

* Effective range varies depending on the installation environment and location.

Security:

WEP (64/128 bits)

WPA-PSK (TKIP/AES)

WPA2-PSK (TKIP/AES)

Setup:

WPS (Push button configuration/PIN code method)

WCN (WCN-NET)
Easy wireless connect

Other Features: Administration password

Minimum System Requirements


Conform to the operating system's requirements when higher than those given here.

Windows
Operating System Windows 10, Windows 8.1, Windows 7 SP1

Note: Operation can only be guaranteed on a PC with pre-installed Windows


7 or later.

199
Hard Disk Space 3.0 GB or more

Note: For bundled software installation.

The necessary amount of hard disk space may be changed without notice.

Display XGA 1024 x 768

macOS
Operating System OS X 10.10.5 - OS X 10.11, macOS 10.12 - macOS 10.13

Hard Disk Space 1.5 GB or more

Note: For bundled software installation.

The necessary amount of hard disk space may be changed without notice.

Display XGA 1024 x 768

Other Supported OS
iOS, Android, Windows 10 Mobile

Some functions may not be available with the supported OS.

Refer to the Canon web site for details.

Mobile Printing Capability


Apple AirPrint

Google Cloud Print

PIXMA Cloud Link

Windows 10 Mobile Print

Mopria Print Service

• Internet connection or CD-ROM drive is required to install the software for Windows.

• Internet connection is required to use Easy-WebPrint EX and/or Easy-PhotoPrint Editor and all the
user's guide.
• Easy-WebPrint EX: Internet Explorer 8, 9, 10 and 11 (for Windows) is required.

• Windows: Some functions may not be available with Windows Media Center.

• Windows: The TWAIN driver (ScanGear) is based on the TWAIN 1.9 Specification and requires the
Data Source Manager bundled with the operating system.

• macOS: For macOS, an internet connection is required during software installation.

• In an in-house network environment, the 5222 port must be open. Contact the network
administrator for details.

Information in this manual is subject to change without notice.

200
Information about Paper

Supported Media Types

Paper Load Limit

Unsupported Media Types

Handling Paper

Print Area

201
Supported Media Types

For best results, choose paper designed for how you are printing. A variety of paper for documents as well
as photos or illustrations is available from Canon. Use genuine Canon paper to print important photos, when
possible.

Media Types

Genuine Canon paper


Note
• For warnings on use of the non-printable side, see each product's usage information.
• For details on page sizes and media types, access the Canon website.

• Genuine Canon paper is not available in some countries or regions. Note that in the United States,
Canon paper is not sold by model number. Instead, purchase paper by name.

Paper for printing documents:

• Canon Red Label Superior <WOP111>

• Canon Océ Office Colour Paper <SAT213>

• High Resolution Paper <HR-101N>*1

Paper for printing photos:


• Photo Paper Pro Platinum <PT-101>

• Glossy Photo Paper "Everyday Use" <GP-501>

• Photo Paper Glossy <GP-701>

• Photo Paper Plus Glossy II <PP-201/PP-301>

• Photo Paper Pro Luster <LU-101>


• Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss <SG-201>

• Matte Photo Paper <MP-101>

Paper other than genuine Canon paper


• Plain Paper (including recycled paper)

• Envelopes*1

• Greeting Card*1

*1 Printing to this paper from the operation panel is not supported.

Paper Load Limit


Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)

202
Page Sizes
You can use the following page sizes.

Note
• Page sizes and media types the printer supports differ depending on the OS you are using.

Standard sizes:

• Letter

• Legal

• A5

• A4
• B5

• KG/4"x6"(10x15)

• 5"x7"(13x18cm)

• 8"x10"(20x25cm)

• L(89x127mm)

• 2L(127x178mm)

• Hagaki

• Hagaki 2

• Envelope Com 10

• Envelope DL

• Nagagata 3

• Nagagata 4

• Yougata 4
• Yougata 6

Special sizes
Special page sizes must be within the following limits:

• Minimum size: 3.50 x 5.00 inches (89.0 x 127.0 mm)

• Maximum size: 8.50 x 26.61 inches (215.9 x 676.0 mm)

Paper Weight
You can use paper in the following weight range.

• 17 to 28 lb (64 to 105 g /m2) (plain paper other than genuine Canon paper)

203
Paper Load Limit

Genuine Canon Paper

Paper for printing documents:

Media Name <Model No.> Cassette Paper Output Tray

Canon Red Label Superior <WOP111> Approx. 100 sheets Approx. 50 sheets

Canon Océ Office Colour Paper <SAT213> Approx. 80 sheets Approx. 40 sheets

High Resolution Paper <HR-101N>*1 Approx. 80 sheets Approx. 40 sheets

Paper for printing photos:

Media Name <Model No.> Cassette Paper Output Tray

Photo Paper Pro Platinum <PT-101>*2 A4, Letter, 8" x 10" (20 x 25 *3
cm): 10 sheets

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Glossy Photo Paper "Everyday Use" <GP-501>*2 A4, Letter: 10 sheets *3

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Photo Paper Glossy <GP-701>*2 A4, Letter: 10 sheets *3

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Photo Paper Plus Glossy II <PP-201/PP-301>*2 A4, Letter, 5" x 7" (13 x 18 *3
cm), 8" x 10" (20 x 25 cm): 10
sheets

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Photo Paper Pro Luster <LU-101>*2 A4, Letter: 10 sheets *3

Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss <SG-201>*2 A4, Letter, 5" x 7" (13 x 18 *3
cm), 8" x 10" (20 x 25 cm): 10
sheets

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Matte Photo Paper <MP-101> A4, Letter: 10 sheets *3

4" x 6" (10 x 15 cm): 20 sheets

Paper other than Genuine Canon Paper


Common Name Cassette Paper Output Tray

Plain Paper (including recycled paper)*1 Approx. 100 sheets Approx. 50 sheets
(Legal: 10 sheets) (Legal: 10 sheets)

Envelopes 5 envelopes *3

Greeting Card Letter: 1 sheet *3

204
*1 Normal feeding at maximum capacity may not be possible with some types of paper, or under very high
or low temperature or humidity. In this case, load half the amount of paper or less.
*2 Feeding from a loaded stack of paper may leave marks on the printed side or prevent efficient feeding.
In this case, load one sheet at a time.
*3 For best results in continuous printing, remove printed paper or envelopes from the paper output tray to
avoid smearing or discoloration.

205
Unsupported Media Types

Do not use the following types of paper. Using such paper will cause not only unsatisfactory results, but also
the printer to jam or malfunction.

• Folded, curled, or wrinkled paper

• Damp paper

• Paper that is too thin (weighing less than 17 lb (64 g /m2))

• Paper that is too thick (plain paper weighing more than 28 lb (105 g /m2), except for Canon genuine
paper)

• Paper thinner than a postcard, including plain paper or notepad paper cut to a small size (when printing
on paper smaller than A5)

• Picture postcards

• Postcards

• Envelopes with a double flap

• Envelopes with an embossed or treated surface

• Envelopes whose gummed flaps are already moistened and adhesive

• Any type of paper with holes

• Paper that is not rectangular

• Paper bound with staples or glue

• Paper with an adhesive surface on the back such as label seal

• Paper decorated with glitter, etc.

206
Handling Paper

• Be careful not to rub or scratch the surfaces of any types of paper when handling.

• Hold the paper as closely as possible to its edges and try not to touch the printing surface. The print
quality may be degraded if the printing surface is smudged with sweat or oil that comes from your
hands.

• Do not touch the printed surface until the ink is dried. Even when the ink is dried, be careful not to touch
the printed surface as much as possible when handling. Due to the nature of the pigment ink, the ink on
the printed surface may be removed when being rubbed or scratched.

• Take out only the necessary number of paper from the package, just before printing.

• To avoid curling, when you do not print, put unused paper back into the package and keep it on a level
surface. And also, store it avoiding heat, humidity, and direct sunlight.

207
Printing

Printing from Computer Printing from Smartphone/Tablet

Printing Using Operation Panel


Paper Settings

208
Printing from Computer

Printing from Application Software (Windows Printer Driver)

Printing from Application Software (macOS AirPrint)

Printing Using Canon Application Software

Printing Using a Web Service

209
Printing from Application Software (macOS AirPrint)

Printing Basic

Printing on Postcards

Adding Printer

How to Open Printer Settings Screen

Displaying the Printing Status Screen

Deleting the Undesired Print Job

Removing Printer That Is No Longer Required from List of Printers

210
Printing

This printer is compatible with the macOS standard printing system (AirPrint).
You can start printing right away after connecting this printer to your Mac without installing any special
software.

Checking Your Environment


First, check your environment.
• AirPrint Operation Environment
Mac running the latest version of OS
• Requirement
The Mac and the printer must be connected by one of the following methods:
◦ Connected to the same network over a LAN
◦ Connected directly without wireless router (Direct Connection)
◦ Connected by USB

Print from a Mac

1. Check that printer is turned on

Note
• If Auto power on is enabled, printer automatically turns itself on when receiving a print job.

2. Load paper in printer

3. Select paper size and paper type from printer


Register the set paper size and paper type on the printer operation panel.
For instructions, see "Paper Settings."

4. Start printing from your application software


The Print dialog opens.

5. Select printer
Select your model from the Printer list in the Print dialog.

211
Note
• Click Show Details to switch the setup window to the detailed display.

6. Check print settings


Set items such as Paper Size to the appropriate size, as well as Media Type from Media & Quality of
the pop-up menu.
Select Auto Select for Media Type.
Remove the Two-Sided check mark if you are not printing on both sides of the paper.

Important
• An error may occur if the paper size set in the print dialog is different from the paper size set on
the printer. Select the correct items on the print dialog and the printer that correspond to the
paper being printed.

212
• If printing paper such as photo paper and postcards that cannot be printed on both sides,
uncheck the Two-Sided checkbox.

Note
• Use the Print dialog to set general print settings such as the layout and the print sequence.
For information about print settings, refer to macOS help.

7. Click Print
The printer prints according to the specified settings.

Note
• It can take the Wi-Fi a few minutes to get connected after the printer turns on. Print after checking
that the printer is connected to the network.
• You cannot print if Bonjour settings of printer are disabled. Check LAN settings of printer and enable
Bonjour settings.
• Refer to "Cannot Print Using AirPrint" for printing problems.
• The display of the settings screen may differ depending on the application software you are using.

Printing of Envelopes
For printing on the envelope from Mac, refer to the following.

Print result image Orientation of print data Orientation of loading envelope

The print data is rotated by 180 degrees Load the envelope in vertically with the address side
against the print result image. facing up so that the folded flap of the envelope will
be faced down on the right side.

213
Printing on Postcards

This section describes the procedure for printing on postcards.

1. Load postcards in printer

2. Select paper size and paper type from the printer


Register Hagaki for paper size from the printer operation panel.
Also, register Hagaki, IJ Hagaki, or Hagaki K for paper type, according to your purpose. When you print
on the address side, register Hagaki.

3. Select Paper Size and Media Type from the print dialog
Select Postcard or Postcard Borderless for Paper Size from the print dialog. When you print on the
address side, select Postcard.
Select Auto Select for Media Type from the print dialog.

Important
• This printer cannot print on postcards that have photos or stickers attached.

4. Uncheck Two-Sided

214
Important
• Two-sided printing is not possible for postcards, so remove the Two-Sided check mark. If you
print with the Two-Sided check mark on, the printing result may not be as you intended.
• You will get cleaner printing if you print the message side first and then print the address side.

5. Click Print
The printer prints according to the specified settings.

215
Adding Printer

Procedure for adding printer to your Mac is explained.

To re-add a printer that was deleted, open System Preferences -> Printers & Scanners, click + next to the
printer list, and then perform the procedure described below.

If your printer is connected via USB, and you connect the USB cable to a Mac, the printer is automatically
added. The below procedure is not necessary in this case.

1. Check whether Default is selected in the displayed dialog

Note
• It may take a little time for the name of your printer to appear.

2. Select the printer


Select the printer listed as Bonjour Multifunction.

Note
• Check the following if printer does not appear.
• Printer is on
• Firewall function of the security software is off
• Printer is either connected to the wireless router or directly connected to the PC (Direct
Connection)

3. Select Secure AirPrint from Use

4. Click Add
The printer is added to your Mac.

216
How to Open Printer Settings Screen

The settings screen of the printer can be displayed from your application software.

Opening the Page Setup Dialog


Use this procedure to set the page (paper) settings before printing.

1. Select Page Setup... from the File menu of the application software
The Page Setup dialog opens.

Opening the Print Dialog


Use this procedure to set the print settings before printing.

1. Select Print... from the File menu of the application software


The Print dialog opens.

217
Displaying the Printing Status Screen

Check the print progress according to the following procedure:

1. Launch the printing status screen


• If the print data has been sent to the printer
The printing status screen opens automatically. To display the printing status screen, click the
(the printer icon) displayed on the Dock.
• If the print data has not been sent to the printer
Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners.
To display the printing status screen, select the name of your printer model from the printer list,
and then click Open Print Queue....

2. Check the printing status


You can check the name of the file being printed or ready for being printed.

Deletes the specified print job.

Stops printing the specified document.

Resumes printing the specified document.

Stops printing all documents.

Displayed only when printing of all documents is being stopped, and resumes printing all docu-
ments.

Important
• If an error occurs, an error message will appear on the printing progress confirmation screen.
• The content of the error message may differ depending on the OS version.
• The printer part names in the error message may differ from what is listed in this manual.
• If the content of the error message is difficult to understand, check the error message displayed on the
printer operation panel.

218
Deleting the Undesired Print Job

If the printer does not start printing, canceled or failed print job data may be remaining.
Delete unnecessary print jobs from the print status check screen.

1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners

2. Select your model, and then click Open Print Queue...


The print status check screen appears.

3. Select the unnecessary print job and click (Delete)


The selected print jobs will be deleted.

219
Removing Printer That Is No Longer Required from List of
Printers

The printer that is no longer in use can be removed from the list of printers.
Before removing the printer, remove the cable connecting the printer and PC.

You cannot remove the printer if not logged in as the administrator. For information about an administrative
user, see Users & Groups from System Preferences.

1. Open System Preferences, and select Printers & Scanners

2. Delete printer from list of printers


Select the printer you wish to remove from the list of printers and click -.
Click Delete Printer when the confirmation message appears.

220
Printing Using Canon Application Software

Easy-PhotoPrint Editor Guide

221
Printing Using a Web Service

Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link

Printing with Google Cloud Print

222
Printing from Smartphone/Tablet

Printing from iPhone/iPad/iPod touch (iOS)

Printing from Smartphone/Tablet (Android)

Printing from Windows 10 Mobile Device

Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct

223
Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct

You can connect devices (e.g. computer, smartphone, or tablet) to the printer by two methods below.

• Wireless connection (connecting devices via a wireless router)

• Direct wireless connection (connecting devices using Wireless Direct)


This section describes Wireless Direct, which allows you to print or scan by connecting the devices to the
printer directly.

Follow the procedure below to use Wireless Direct.

1. Preparing the printer.

Changing Printer Setting to Use Wireless Direct


2. Preparing a device to connect to the printer.

Changing Settings of a Device and Connecting It to the Printer

3. Printing/Scanning.

Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct

Important
• You can connect up to 5 devices to the printer at the same time.

• Check the usage restrictions and switch the printer to the Wireless Direct.

Restrictions

Changing Printer Setting to Use Wireless Direct

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.

4. Select LAN settings and then press the OK button.

5. Select Wireless Direct and then press the OK button.

6. Select Switch WL Direct and then press the OK button.

7. Select Yes and then press the OK button.


When the setting is completed, the Wireless router info screen is displayed.

8. Select Done and then press the OK button.

224
The Wireless Direct is enabled and a device can be connected to the printer wirelessly.

Note
• You can check the following on the Wireless router info screen. Use the button to select
an item you want to check and then press the OK button.
• Network name(SSID): Identifier

• Security protocol: Security setting and password

• WL Direct dev. name: Printer name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device

The password is required when connecting a device to the printer. Depending on the device you
are using, no password is required.
When you connect a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device to the printer, select the printer name from
your device.
• For details on how to update the identifier (SSID) and the security setting, refer to the following.
Changing Wireless Direct Setting

Changing Settings of a Device and Connecting It to the Printer

1. Turn on Wi-Fi function on your device.


Enable "Wi-Fi" on your device's "Setting" menu.

For more on turning on Wi-Fi function, see your device's instruction manual.

2. Select "DIRECT-XXXX-TR4500series" ("X" represents alphanumeric characters) from list


displayed on your device.

Note
• If "DIRECT-XXXX-TR4500series" does not appear on the list, Wireless Direct is not enabled.

See Changing Printer Setting to Use Wireless Direct to enable Wireless Direct.

3. Enter password.
Your device is connected to the printer.

Note
• You can check the password by printing the network settings from the printer.

Printing Network Settings


• Depending on the device you are using, no password is required.

• If your Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is set to prioritize using Wi-Fi Direct and it is connecting
to the printer, the printer displays a confirmation screen asking if you allow the device to
connect to the printer.

Make sure the name on the LCD is the same as that of your wireless communication device
and select Yes and press the OK button.

225
Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct
After connecting a device and the printer, start printing/scanning from the application of your device.

Note
• For more on printing or scanning from a device via Wi-Fi, refer to the device's or application's
instruction manual.

• You can print/scan from your smartphone or tablet by installing Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.
Download it from App Store and Google Play.

For iOS
For Android

Changing Wireless Direct Setting


Change the settings for the Wireless Direct following the procedure below.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Device settings and then press the OK button.

4. Select LAN settings and then press the OK button.

5. Select Wireless Direct and then press the OK button.

6. Select a setting item and then press the OK button.


Change name (SSID)
Updates the identifier (SSID) for Wireless Direct or the printer name displayed on a Wi-Fi Direct
compatible device.
• Manual setup

1. Select Manual setup and then press the OK button.

2. Enter new printer name and then press the OK button.

3. Confirm your entries and press the OK button.

• Auto update

1. Select Auto update and then press the OK button.

2. Select Yes and then press the OK button.

3. Select Done and then press the OK button.

If you select Network name(SSID) and press the OK button, you can check the updated
identifier (SSID).

226
Change password
• Manual setup
1. Select Manual setup and then press the OK button.

2. Enter new password and then press the OK button.


• Auto update

1. Select Auto update and then press the OK button.


2. Select Yes and then press the OK button.

3. Select Done and then press the OK button.


If you select Security protocol instead of Done, you can check the updated password.
Confirm request
To display the confirmation screen when a Wi-Fi Direct compatible device is connecting to the
printer, select Yes and press the OK button.

Important
• To prevent an unauthorized access, we recommend you should not change the setting from
the default.

Note
• If you change the Wireless Direct setting of the printer, also change the wireless router setting of the
device.

227
Paper Settings

By registering the paper size and the media type loaded in the cassette, you can prevent the printer from
misprinting by displaying the message before printing starts when the paper size or the media type of the
loaded paper differs from the paper settings for printing.

Note
• The default setting is different between when you print/copy from the operation panel, when you print
from Smartphone/tablet, when you print from Windows, and when you print from macOS.

Default Setting for Displaying the Message which Prevents Misprinting

When you insert the cassette with paper loaded:

The screen to register the paper information is displayed.

Register the paper size and the media type according to the loaded paper.

Important
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver for
Windows and on the LCD:
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)

When the paper settings for printing/copying are different from the
paper information registered in the printer:
Ex:
• Paper settings for printing/copying: A5

• Paper information registered in the printer: A4

228
When you start printing/copying, The size/type of loaded paper is different from the print settings
appears on the LCD.

When you press the OK button, the screen for selecting the processing method is displayed. Please
choose one of the following.

Note
• Depending on the setting, the choices below may not be displayed.

Use cass. settings


Select if you want to print on the paper loaded without changing the paper settings.

For example, when the paper size setting for printing/copying is A5 and the paper information
registered in the printer is A4, the printer starts printing/copying on the paper loaded in the cassette
without changing the paper size setting for printing/copying.

Replace the paper


Select if you want to print after replacing the paper of the cassette.

For example, when the paper size setting for printing/copying is A5 and the paper information
registered in the printer is A4, you load A5 sized paper before you start printing/copying.

After replacing the paper and pushing the cassette back, the paper information registration screen
appears. Register the paper information in the printer in accordance with the paper loaded in the
cassette.

Note
• For more on the proper combination of paper settings you can specify by the printer driver for
Windows and on the LCD:

Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type)
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size)

Cancel
Cancels printing.

Select when you change the paper settings specified for printing/copying. Change the paper settings
and try printing/copying again.

229
Default Setting for Displaying the Message which Prevents Misprinting

• When you print/copy using the operation panel of the printer or when you print from
smartphone/tablet:

The message which prevents misprinting is enabled by default.

To change the setting:

Feed settings

• When you print from Windows:

The message which prevents misprinting is disabled by default.

To change the setting:


Changing the Printer Operation Mode

• When you print from macOS:

The message which prevents misprinting is enabled by default.

To change the setting:

Changing the Printer Operation Mode

Important
• When the message which prevents misprinting is disabled:

The printer starts printing/copying even though the paper settings for printing/copying and the paper
information registered in the printer are different.

230
Copying

Reducing/Enlarging Copies
Making Copies Basics

Two-Sided Copying Collated Copying

Special Copy Menu Copying Using Smartphone or Tablet

231
Making Copies

This section describes the basic procedure to perform standard copying.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load paper.

3. Press the COPY button.


The Copy standby screen is displayed.

4. Load original document on platen or in ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

5. Confirm the page size (A) and magnification (B).

Note
• To change or confirm the page size, magnification, or other settings, press the Menu/Wireless
connect button, then use the button to display the desired setting item.
Setting Items for Copying

• Press the COPY button to reset the magnification to 100%.

6. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to specify the number of copies.

7. Press the Color button for color copying, or the Black button for black & white copying.
The printer starts copying.

Remove the original on the platen or from the document output slot after copying is complete.

Important
• If you load the original on the platen, do not open the document cover or remove the original while
Scanning... is displayed on the screen.
• If you load the original in the ADF, do not move the original until copying is complete.

Note
• To cancel copying, press the Stop button.

• If you load the original on the platen, you can add the copying job while printing.

Adding the Copying Job (Reserve copy)

232
Adding the Copying Job (Reserve copy)
If you load the original on the platen, you can add the copying job while printing (Reserve copy).

The screen like shown below is displayed when you can reserve copy.

Load the original on the platen and press the same button (the Color button or the Black button) as the
one which you previously pressed.

Important
• When you load the original on the platen, open and close the document cover gently.

Note
• When Print quality is set High, or you load the original in the ADF, you cannot add the copying job.

• When you add the copying job, the number of copies or the settings such as the page size or media
type cannot be changed.
• If you press the Stop button while reserve copying is in progress, the screen to select the method to
cancel copying is displayed. If you select Cancel all reserv. then press the OK button, you can
cancel copying all scanned data. If you select Cancel last reserv. then press the OK button, you can
cancel the last copying job.
• If you set a document of too many pages to reserve copy, Memory is full may appear on the LCD.
Press the OK button and wait a while, then try copying again.
• If Try again appears on the LCD when scanning, press the OK button, then press the Stop button to
cancel copying. After that, copy the documents that have not been finished copying.

233
Setting Items for Copying

You can change the copy settings such as the page size, media type, and intensity.

In the copy mode, press the Menu/Wireless connect button, use the button to select a setting item,
then press the OK button.

Use the button to adjust each setting item, then press the OK button. The next setting item is
displayed.

The LCD returns to the Copy standby screen when all the settings are complete.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.
• Some settings cannot be specified in combination with the setting of other setting items or the copy
menu.

• The settings of the page size, media type, etc. are retained even if the printer is turned off.

• Enlarge/Reduce

Select the reduction/enlargement method.

Reducing/Enlarging Copies

Ex:

Note
• This setting item is displayed under the following conditions.

• When standard copying is selected

• When Borderless copy is selected for Special copy

• Copy intensity

Change the intensity (brightness).

Ex:

Note
• If you select Auto adjust, load the original on the platen.

• If you select Manual adjust, use the button to decrease the intensity or the button to
increase it.

• Page size

Select the page size of the loaded paper.

Ex:

234
Note
• Some of setting items are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• Media type

Select the media type of the loaded paper.

Ex:

• Print quality
Select the print quality according to the original.

Ex:

Note
• If you use Draft with the media type set to Plain paper and the quality is not as good as expected,
select Standard or High and try copying again.

• Select High to copy in grayscale. Grayscale renders tones in a range of grays instead of black or
white.

• 4-on-1 layout
Select the layout when copying four original pages onto a single sheet of paper by reducing each image.
Four different layouts are available.

Ex:

Note
• This setting item is displayed only when 4-on-1 copy is selected for Special copy.
Copying Four Pages onto Single Page

• Collate
Select whether to obtain sorted printouts when making multiple copies of a multi-paged original.

Collated Copying

Ex:

235
Note
• This setting item is displayed when standard copying is selected.

• 2-sided
Select whether to perform two-sided copying.

Ex:

Note
• This setting item is displayed only when 2-sided copy is selected for Special copy.
Two-Sided Copying

• Stapling side

Select the orientation and the stapling side of the printed paper.

Ex:

Note
• This setting item is displayed only when 2-sided copy is selected for Special copy.

Two-Sided Copying

236
Scanning

Scanning from Computer (Windows)


Scanning from Computer (macOS)

Scanning from Operation Panel


Scanning Using Smartphone/Tablet

237
Scanning from Computer (macOS)

Scanning According to Item Type or Purpose (IJ Scan Utility Lite)

IJ Scan Utility Lite Features

Scanning Easily (Auto Scan) Basics

Scanning Documents and Photos

Scanning Tips

Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)

238
Scanning According to Item Type or Purpose (IJ Scan Utility
Lite)

IJ Scan Utility Lite Features

Scanning Easily (Auto Scan) Basics

Scanning Documents and Photos

Important
• Available functions and settings vary depending on your scanner or printer.

239
IJ Scan Utility Lite Features

Use IJ Scan Utility Lite to scan and save documents, photos, or other items at one time by simply clicking
the corresponding icon.

Important
• The displayed items and available functions vary depending on your scanner or printer.

Multiple Scanning Modes


Auto allows for one click scanning with default settings for various items. Document will sharpen text in a
document or magazine for better readability, and Photo is best suited for scanning photos.

Note
• For details on the IJ Scan Utility Lite main screen, see IJ Scan Utility Lite Main Screen.

Save Scanned Images Automatically


Scanned images are automatically saved to a preset folder. The folder can be changed as needed.

Note
• The default save folder is the Pictures folder.
• For how to specify a folder, see Settings Dialog.

Application Integration
Scanned images can be sent to other applications. For example, display scanned images in your favorite
graphics application, attach them to e-mails, or extract text from images.

240
Note
• To set the applications to integrate with, see Settings Dialog.

241
Scanning Easily (Auto Scan)

Auto Scan allows for automatic detection of the type of the item placed on the platen or ADF (Auto
Document Feeder).

Important
• This function is not supported depending on your model.

• The following types of items may not be scanned correctly. In that case, adjust the cropping frames
(selection boxes; scan areas) in the screen displayed by clicking Driver in the IJ Scan Utility Lite main
screen, and then scan again.

• Photos with a whitish background


• Items printed on white paper, hand-written text, business cards, and other unclear items
• Thin items
• Thick items

• When scanning two or more documents from the ADF, place documents of the same size.

1. Check that scanner or printer is turned on.

2. Place items on platen or ADF.


Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)

3. Start IJ Scan Utility Lite.

4. Click Auto.

Scanning starts.

Note
• To cancel the scan, click Cancel.
• Use the Settings (Auto Scan) dialog to set where to save the scanned images and to make advanced
scan settings.
• To scan a specific item type, see the following pages.

Scanning Documents and Photos


Scanning with Favorite Settings

242
Scanning Multiple Documents at One Time from the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

243
Scanning Documents and Photos

Scan items placed on the platen with settings suitable for documents or photos.

Save documents in formats such as PDF and JPEG, and photos in formats such as JPEG and TIFF.

1. Place the item on the platen.


Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)

2. Start IJ Scan Utility Lite.

3. To specify the paper size, resolution, PDF settings, etc., click Settings..., and then set each
item in the Settings dialog.

Note
• Once settings are made in the Settings dialog, the same settings can be used for scanning from
the next time.
• In the Settings dialog, specify image processing settings such as slant correction, set where to
save the scanned images, and more, as needed.

When setting is completed, click OK.

4. Click Document or Photo.

Scanning starts.

Note
• To cancel the scan, click Cancel.

244
Scanning Tips

Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)

245
Positioning Originals (Scanning from Computer)

This section describes how to load originals on the platen or ADF (Auto Document Feeder) for scanning. If
items are not placed correctly they may not be scanned correctly.

Important
• Be sure to observe the following when loading the original on the platen. Failure to observe the
following may cause the scanner to malfunction or the platen glass to break.

• Do not place any objects weighing 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass.
• Do not put any pressure of 4.4 lb (2.0 kg) or more on the platen glass, such as pressing down the
original.

• Close the document cover when scanning.


• Do not touch the operation panel buttons or LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) when opening/closing the
document cover. May result in unintended operation.

Placing Items (Platen)


Placing Documents (ADF (Auto Document Feeder))

Placing Items (Platen)


Place items as described below to scan by detecting the item type and size automatically.

Important
• Depending on your model, the function to scan by automatically detecting the item type and size
does not appear.
• When scanning by specifying the paper size, align an upper corner of the item with the corner at the
arrow (alignment mark) of the platen.
• Photos that have been cut to irregular shapes and items smaller than 1.2 inches (3 cm) square
cannot be cropped accurately when scanning.
• Reflective disc labels may not be scanned as expected.
• If scanned by detecting the item type and size automatically, the response may differ. In that case,
adjust the cropping frame (selection box) manually.

Photos, Postcards, Business Cards, and BD/DVD/CD Magazines, Newspapers, and Documents

Place the item face-down on the platen and align an


Single item:
upper corner of the item with the corner at the arrow
Place the item face-down on the platen, with 0.4 inch (1 cm) (alignment mark) of the platen. Portions placed on
or more space between the edges (diagonally striped area) the diagonally striped area cannot be scanned.
of the platen and the item. Portions placed on the diagonally
striped area cannot be scanned.

246
Important Important
• Large items (such as A4 size photos) that cannot be • For the portions in which items cannot be scan-
placed away from the edges/arrow (alignment mark) of ned, click Home to return to the top page of the
the platen may be saved as PDF files. To save in a for- Online Manual for your model and search for
mat other than PDF, scan by specifying the data format. "Loading Originals."

Multiple items:

Allow 0.4 inch (1 cm) or more space between the edges (di-
agonally striped area) of the platen and items, and between
items. Portions placed on the diagonally striped area cannot
be scanned.

: 0.4 inch (1 cm) or more

Note
• In IJ Scan Utility Lite, place up to 12 items.
• Positions of slanted items (10 degrees or less) are cor-
rected automatically.

Placing Documents (ADF (Auto Document Feeder))


Important
• Do not leave thick items on the platen when scanning from the ADF. May result in paper jam.
• Place and align documents of the same size when scanning two or more documents.
• For supported document sizes when scanning from the ADF, click Home to return to the top page of
the Online Manual for your model and search for "Supported Originals."

247
1. Make sure any original has been removed from platen.

2. Open document tray (A).

3. Slide the paper guides (B) all the way out.

4. Load document with side to scan facing up in document tray.


Insert the document until it stops.

5. Adjust document guide (B) to match width of document.


Do not slide the document guide too hard against the document. The document may not be fed
properly.

Note
• When scanning duplex documents, place the front sides facing up. They will not be scanned correctly
if placed the other way around.

248
Scanning Using Smartphone/Tablet

Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link

Printing/Scanning with Wireless Direct

249
Faxing

Preparing for Faxing Registering Recipients

Sending Faxes from Computer (Windows)


Sending Faxes Using Operation Panel of
Printer

Sending Faxes from Computer (Mac OS) Receiving Faxes

Other Useful Fax Functions

250
Preparing for Faxing

Connect the printer to the telephone line and set up the printer before using the faxing functions. Then
specify the basic setting such as sender information, date/time, and daylight saving time.

Important
• If the Power Disconnects:
If there is a power failure or if you accidentally unplug the power cord, the date/time settings will be
reset.

• The settings for user information and directory will be retained.

• All faxes stored in the printer's memory, such as unsent and received faxes, will be lost.
If the power disconnects, the following will apply:

• You will not be able to send or receive faxes, make copies, or scan originals.

• When you are connecting the telephone, whether or not you can use it depends upon your
telephone line or telephone.

Setting Up Printer
The printer must be set up depending on your telephone line and use of the faxing function.

All Setup
FAX Setup Guide

Individual Setup

Step1 Connecting Telephone Line

Step2 Setting Telephone Line Type

Step3 Setting Receive Mode

Step4 Setting Sender Information

Note
• You can set the fax setting according to the instruction on the LCD.

Easy setup

If you set up according to the instruction on the LCD, the receive mode is set to TEL priority mode
or Fax only mode. To receive faxes with DRPD or Network switch, change the receive mode.

Setting Receive Mode

251
Connecting Telephone Line

The connection method differs depending on your telephone line.

• If you connect the printer to wall telephone line directly/If you connect the printer with the xDSL splitter:
Basic Connection (Connecting with General Telephone line)

• If you connect the printer to another line such as an xDSL:

Connecting Various Lines

If the connection is incorrect, the printer cannot send/receive faxes. Connect the printer correctly.

Important
• Do not connect fax devices and/or telephones in parallel (US and Canada only).
If two or more fax devices and/or telephones are connected in parallel, the following problems may
occur and the printer may not operate properly.

• If you pick up the handset of the telephone that is connected in parallel during fax transmission or
reception, the fax image may be corrupted or a communication error may occur.

• Such services as Caller ID, etc. may not operate properly on the telephone.

If you cannot avoid parallel connections, set the receive mode to TEL priority mode, understanding
that the above problems may occur. You will only be able to receive faxes manually.

Basic Connection (Connecting with General Telephone line)


Make sure that the printer is turned off, connect one end of supplied telephone line cable to the telephone
line jack near the "LINE" mark of the printer, then connect the other end to the telephone line jack on the
wall or to the telephone line jack of the xDSL splitter.

When you connect the telephone to the printer, make sure that the printer is turned off, connect one end
of the modular cable to the external device jack near the "EXT." mark of the printer, then connect the other
end to the telephone line jack of the telephone.

252
Important
• Be sure to connect the telephone line before the printer is turned on.
If you connect the telephone line when the printer is turned on, turn the printer off and unplug the
power cord. Wait for 1 minute then connect the telephone line and power plug.

Note
• Refer to Rear View for the position of the telephone line jack and the external device jack.

• Before connecting a telephone or answering machine, remove the Telephone connector cap.

• For users in the UK:

If the connector of the external device cannot be connected to the jack on the printer, you will need to
purchase a B.T. adapter to connect as follows:

Attach the B.T. adapter to the modular cable connecting the external device, then connect the B.T.
adapter to the external device jack.

Connecting Various Lines


This section introduces how to connect various lines.

These are examples and could not be guaranteed to suit every connecting condition. For details, refer to
the instruction manual supplied with the network device (control devices such as an xDSL (Digital
Subscriber Line) modem or terminal adapter) you are connecting to this printer.

Note
• xDSL is the generic term for the high speed digital communication technology with telephone line
such as ADSL/HDSL/SDSL/VDSL.

253
• Connecting to an Internet Telephone

A: Digital Subscriber Line


B: xDSL modem (splitter may not be built-in to the modem)
C: Broadband router compatible with Internet Telephone
D: Computer
E: Telephone or answering machine
F: WAN (Wide Area Network) port
G: LAN (Local Area Network) port
H: TEL port
I: LINE port

* Port configurations and names may vary depending on the product.

Note
• When connecting to the xDSL line, select the same line type as you are subscribing to in
Telephone line type.

Setting Telephone Line Type

• Connecting to an xDSL

A: Analog Subscriber Line


B: xDSL modem (splitter may not be built-in to the modem)
C: Computer
D: Telephone or answering machine

Important
• When the splitter is not built-in to the modem, do not branch the telephone line before the splitter
(wall side). And also, do not connect splitters in parallel. The printer may not be able to operate
properly.

Note
• When connecting to the xDSL line, select the same line type as you are subscribing to in
Telephone line type.

254
Setting Telephone Line Type

• Connecting to an ISDN Line


For details on ISDN (Integrated Service Digital Network) connection and settings, refer to the manuals
supplied with your terminal adapter or dial-up router.

255
Setting Telephone Line Type

Before using your printer, make sure you set the correct telephone line type for your telephone line. If you
are unsure of your telephone line type, contact your telephone company. For xDSL or ISDN connections,
contact the telephone company or service provider to confirm your line type.

Important

• For users in China

After plugging the power cord and turning on the printer, the telephone line type is selected
automatically. However, if the printer is connected to the control device such as an xDSL modem or
terminal adapter, the telephone line type may not be selected correctly.
In this case, set the line type manually.

For details on how to set the Telephone line type manually in China:

Setting the Telephone Line Type Manually in China

Note
• Telephone line type will not appear in countries or regions where Rotary pulse is not supported.

• You can print USER'S DATA LIST to check the current setting.

Summary of Reports and Lists

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.

4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.

5. Select Telephone line type, then press the OK button.

6. Select a telephone line type, then press the OK button.


Rotary pulse
Select when your telephone line type is pulse dialing.

Touch tone
Select when your telephone line type is tone dialing.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

256
7. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

Setting the Telephone Line Type Manually in China


This section describes the procedure to set the telephone line type manually in China.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.

4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.

5. Select TEL line auto select, then press the OK button.


The current telephone line type is displayed.

Note
• If you do not need to change the telephone line type, press the FAX button to return to the Fax
standby screen.

6. Select OFF, then press the OK button.

7. Select a telephone line type, then press the OK button.


Rotary pulse
Select when your telephone line type is pulse dialing.

Touch tone
Select when your telephone line type is tone dialing.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

8. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

257
Setting Receive Mode

Set the receiving operation (receiving mode).

For details on how to set the receive mode:

Setting Receive Mode

You can select the appropriate mode.

For details on the selectable receive mode:

About Receive Mode

For details on the advanced settings of the receive mode:

Advanced Settings of Receive Mode

Note
• The receiving operation procedure varies depending on the selected receive mode.

For details on receiving method depending on each receive mode:

Receiving Faxes
• If you want to use a single telephone line for faxes and voice calls, you need to connect a telephone or
an answering machine to the external device jack of this printer.

For details on how to connect the telephone or the answering machine to the printer:

Basic Connection (Connecting with General Telephone line)

Setting Receive Mode


This section describes the procedure to select the receive mode.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Receive mode set., then press the OK button.

5. Select the receive mode, then press the OK button.


The confirmation message for the advanced settings appears.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.
• For details on the receive mode:

258
About Receive Mode
• DRPD is available only in the US and Canada.
• Network switch may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• Refer to Receiving Faxes for information on receiving faxes or the procedure for each receive
mode.

6. If you make the advanced settings, select Yes and press the OK button. If not, select No
and press the OK button.
Make the advanced settings as necessary.
Advanced Settings of Receive Mode

About Receive Mode


You can select the receive mode suitable for your fax use conditions: whether you use a dedicated line for
fax, etc.

• TEL priority mode

Select when mainly receiving voice calls (with a telephone or answering machine connected to the
printer).

Receiving operation:
1. When a call incomes, the telephone will ring.

2. Pick up the handset.

If the call is a voice call, talk on the telephone.

If the call is a fax, hang up the handset after the printer starts receiving the fax.

Note
• The telephone may not ring when a call incomes even if it is connected to the printer, depending
on the type or settings of the telephone.

• DRPD or Network switch

Select when receiving voice calls (with a telephone or answering machine connected to the printer)
and subscribing to a ring pattern detection service provided by your telephone company.

Receiving operation:

1. When a call incomes, the telephone will ring.

2. The printer detects a fax call by the fax ring pattern.

If the call is a fax, the printer will receive the fax automatically.

If the printer does not detect the fax ring pattern, the telephone will continue ringing.

Note
• The telephone may not ring when a call incomes even if it is connected to the printers, depending
on the type or settings of the telephone.

259
• Fax only mode
Select when not receiving voice calls.

Receiving operation:

1. When a fax incomes, the printer will receive the fax automatically.

Advanced Settings of Receive Mode


You can specify the advanced settings of each receive mode.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

• Advanced setting in TEL priority mode

You can specify the following setting items.

◦ Manual/auto switch

If you select ON, the printer automatically receives faxes after the external device rang a specified
length of time.

Use the button or the Numeric buttons to specify the length of time until automatic reception
is started.

◦ User-friendly RX

If you select ON, the printer automatically switches from telephone calling to fax reception by
detecting the fax signal (CNG signal) when you lift the handset of the telephone or the answering
machine answers. When you have an answering machine connected to the printer, select ON to
switch to fax reception automatically after the answering machine answers.

If you select OFF, the printer does not switch from telephone calling to fax reception automatically
even if the printer detects the fax signal (CNG signal). Select OFF if you want the printer not to
switch automatically during a call.

Note
• If you subscribe to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, the number of times the external device
rings specified with Incoming ring in Fax only mode is available in TEL priority mode.
If you want to specify the number of times the external device rings in TEL priority mode, select
Fax only mode for Receive mode set. under FAX menu, specify the number of times the
external device rings with Incoming ring, then switch to TEL priority mode for Receive mode
set..

• If you subscribe to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, we recommend that Manual/auto
switch be set to OFF.

• Advanced setting in Fax only mode


You can specify the following setting item.

◦ Incoming ring

260
Use the button or the Numeric buttons to specify the number of times the external device
rings when incoming.

• Advanced setting in DRPD


You can specify the following setting items.

◦ DRPD: FAX ring pat.


Sets the distinctive ring pattern of a call that the printer assumes is a fax call.

If you subscribe to a DRPD service, set the ring pattern to match the pattern assigned by your
telephone company.

Setting the DRPD Ring Pattern (US and Canada only)

◦ Incoming ring
You can specify the number of times the external device rings when incoming.

• Advanced setting in Network switch

You can specify the following setting item.

◦ Incoming ring

You can specify the number of times the external device rings when incoming.

Setting the DRPD Ring Pattern (US and Canada only)


If you have subscribed to a Distinctive Ring Pattern Detection (DRPD) service provided by your telephone
company, your telephone company will assign two or more telephone numbers with distinctive ring
patterns to your single telephone line, allowing you to have different numbers for fax calls and voice calls
using only one telephone line. Your printer will automatically monitor the ring pattern, and will
automatically receive the fax if the ring pattern is a fax call.

To use DRPD, follow the procedure below to set the fax ring pattern that matches the pattern assigned by
your telephone company.

Note
• Contact your local telephone company for detailed information on this service.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Receive mode set., then press the OK button.

5. Select DRPD, then press the OK button.

261
The confirmation screen asking whether to make advanced settings is displayed.

6. Select Yes, then press the OK button.

7. Select DRPD: FAX ring pat., then press the OK button.


The DRPD: FAX ring pat. screen is displayed.

8. Select the ring pattern that your telephone company assigned to your fax number, then
press the OK button.

Select from Normal ring, Double ring, Short-short-long, or Short-long-short.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

9. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

262
Setting Sender Information

You can set the sender information such as user information and date/time.

About Sender Information


Setting Date and Time
Setting Daylight Saving Time (Summer Time)
Registering User Information

About Sender Information


If the unit name and unit fax/telephone number are registered, they are printed with date and time as
sender information on the recipient's fax.

A: Date and time of transmission


B: Unit fax/telephone number
C: Unit name
D: The registered recipient's name is printed when sending faxes.
E: Page number

Note
• You can print USER'S DATA LIST to confirm the sender information you have registered.

Summary of Reports and Lists


• When sending faxes in black & white, you can select whether to print the sender information inside or
outside the image area.

Specify the setting on TTI position in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.

Adv. FAX settings


• You can select the date print format from three formats: YYYY/MM/DD, MM/DD/YYYY, and DD/MM/
YYYY.

Select the date print format on Date display format under Other dev. settings.

Other dev. settings

263
Setting Date and Time
This section describes the procedure to set the date and time.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Device settings, then press the OK button.

4. Select Other dev. settings, then press the OK button.

5. Select Date/time setting, then press the OK button.

6. Set the date and time.


Use the button to move the cursor under the desired position, then use the Numeric buttons to
enter the date and time.

Enter the time in 24-hour format.

Enter only the last two digits of the year.

7. Press the OK button.

8. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

Setting Daylight Saving Time (Summer Time)


Some countries adopt the daylight saving time (summer time) system that shifts the clock time forward at
certain periods of the year.

You can set your printer to automatically change the time by registering the date and time that daylight
saving time (summer time) begins and ends.

Important
• Not all the latest information of all countries or regions is applied for DST setting by default. You
need to change the default setting according to the latest information of your country or region.

Note
• This setting may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

264
2. Press the Setup button.
The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Device settings, then press the OK button.

4. Select Other dev. settings, then press the OK button.

5. Select DST setting, then press the OK button.

6. Select ON, then press the OK button.


To disable summer time, select OFF.

7. Set the date and time when summer time starts.


1. Select Start date/time, then press the OK button.
2. Make sure that Set month is selected, then press the OK button.
3. Select the month when summer time starts, then press the OK button.

4. Make sure that Set week is selected, then press the OK button.

5. Select the week when summer time starts, then press the OK button.

6. Make sure that Set day of week is selected, then press the OK button.

7. Select the day of the week when summer time starts, then press the OK button.

8. Make sure that Set shift time is selected, then press the OK button.

9. Use the button to move the cursor under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to
enter the time (in 24-hour format) when summer time starts, then press the OK button.

Precede single digits with a zero.

8. Set the date and time when summer time ends.


1. Use the button to select End date/time, then press the OK button.
2. Make sure that Set month is selected, then press the OK button.

3. Use the button to select the month when summer time ends, then press the OK button.
4. Make sure that Set week is selected, then press the OK button.

5. Use the button to select the week when summer time ends, then press the OK button.
6. Make sure that Set day of week is selected, then press the OK button.

7. Use the button to select the day of the week when summer time ends, then press the OK
button.
8. Make sure that Set shift time is selected, then press the OK button.

265
9. Use the button to move the cursor under the desired position, use the Numeric buttons to
enter the time (in 24-hour format) when summer time ends, then press the OK button.
Precede single digits with a zero.

9. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

Registering User Information


This section describes the procedure to register the user information.

Note
• Before sending a fax, be sure to enter your name and fax/telephone number in Unit TEL no. registr.
and Unit name registr. on the FAX user settings screen (for US only).

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button.


The Setup menu screen is displayed.

3. Select Fax settings, then press the OK button.

4. Select FAX user settings, then press the OK button.

5. Enter the unit fax/telephone number.


1. Make sure that Unit TEL no. registr. is selected, then press the OK button.

2. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the unit fax/telephone number.

3. Press the OK button.

Note
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 20 digits, including spaces.

• For details on how to enter or delete characters:

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

6. Enter the unit name.


1. Make sure that Unit name registr. is selected, then press the OK button.

2. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the unit name.

266
3. Press the OK button.

Note
• You can enter the name up to 24 characters, including spaces.
• For details on how to enter or delete characters:

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

7. Press the FAX button to return to the Fax standby screen.

267
Registering Recipients

Registering Recipients Using Operation Panel of Printer

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS)

268
Registering Recipients Using Operation Panel of Printer

Registering recipients in the printer's directory in advance allows you to dial fax/telephone numbers simply.

The following methods to register are available:

• Recipient registration
Registering the recipient's fax/telephone number and name allows you to send a fax by selecting a
registered recipient in the printer directory.

Registering Fax/Telephone Number of Recipients

• Group dial registration

You can combine two or more recipients registered in advance into a group. You can send the same
document to all the registered recipients in the group.

Registering Recipients in Group Dial

You can register up to 20 recipients in total of individual recipients and group dials.

Note
• To change the registered information of the recipient or the group dial, see Changing Registered
Information.
• To delete the registered information of the recipient or the group dial, see Deleting Registered
Information.
• To print a list of the recipient's fax/telephone numbers and names registered, see Printing List of
Registered Destinations.
• You can register, change, or delete the registered information of the recipient or the group dial using
Speed Dial Utility on the computer.
• For Windows:

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (Windows)

• For macOS:

Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS)

269
Registering Fax/Telephone Number of Recipients

Before you can use the printer's directory, you need to register the recipients' fax/telephone numbers. Follow
the procedure below to register the recipients' fax/telephone numbers.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.

5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the
Setup button.

6. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.


The screen to select an ID number is displayed.

7. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select an unregistered ID number, then press
the OK button.

Note
• If you already registered the recipient, the fax/telephone number is displayed next to the ID
number. If you already registered the group dial, (Not available) is displayed.

8. Select a registration method, then press the OK button.

9. Register the recipients' fax/telephone number.


• From call log (OUT) is selected as the registration method:

The screen to select the fax/telephone number from the outgoing call logs is displayed.

1. Select a fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.

270
The fax/telephone number selected from the outgoing call logs is displayed.
2. Check the fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.
The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's
name is displayed.
• From call log (IN) is selected as the registration method:

The screen to select the fax/telephone number or the name from the incoming call logs is
displayed.

1. Select a fax/telephone number or a name, then press the OK button.


The fax/telephone number selected from the incoming call logs is displayed.
2. Check the fax/telephone number, then press the OK button.
The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's
name is displayed.

Note
• This registration method may not be available depending on the country or region of purchase.

• Direct entry is selected as the registration method:

The screen to enter the fax/telephone number is displayed.

1. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the fax/telephone number you want to register.

2. Press the OK button.

The fax/telephone number is registered to the printer and the screen to enter the recipient's
name is displayed.

Note
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 60 digits (40 digits for the US, Canada,
Korea and some regions of Latin America), including spaces.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

• Press the button twice to enter a pause.


• When Telephone line type in FAX user settings under Fax settings is set to Rotary
pulse, you can enter a tone ("T") by pressing the Tone button.

10. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the recipient's name.

271
If you select a name on From call log (IN) in step 9, the name may be already entered. If you do not
change the name, go to step 11.

Note
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

11. Press the OK button to finalize registration.

Note
• To register another recipient's number and name, select an unregistered ID number and operate
in the same procedure.

• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.


• You can check the recipient's numbers and names you have registered by printing RECIPIENT
TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST.
Printing List of Registered Destinations

272
Registering Recipients in Group Dial

If you register two or more registered recipients to a group dial, you can send the same document
successively to all recipients registered to the group dial.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.

5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the
Setup button.

6. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.


The screen to select an ID number is displayed.

7. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select an unregistered ID number, then press
the OK button.

Note
• If you already registered the recipient, (Not available) is displayed next to the ID number. If you
already registered the group dial, the registered group name is displayed.

The Group member screen is displayed.

8. Register the registered recipient as a member of the group dial.


1. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.

2. Choose a recipient to register as a member.

273
You can choose a recipient with the two methods. The method can be switched by pressing the
button.
• When Add to group is displayed on the LCD:

Use the button to select a recipient's ID number to register to the group dial.

• When Enter first letter is displayed on the LCD:

After you use the Numeric buttons to enter the first letter of the recipient's name you want to
search, the registered recipients are displayed in alphabetical order.

Use the button to select a recipient's ID number to register to the group dial.

3. Press the OK button.


The selected recipient is registered as a member of the group dial.

4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button to display the screen to select an ID number, then add
another member.

Repeat this step to register the other recipient to the same group dial.

Note
• You can check the recipient's ID number and name registered to the group dial by using the
button.

9. Press the OK button after finishing registering the member you want to register to the group
dial.
The screen to enter the group name is displayed.

10. Use the Numeric buttons to enter the group name.

Note
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

274
11. Press the OK button to finalize registration.

Note
• To register another group, select an unregistered ID number and operate in the same procedure.
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.
• You can check the recipients you have registered to the group dial by printing GROUP DIAL
TELEPHONE NO. LIST.
Printing List of Registered Destinations

275
Changing Registered Information

To change information registered for recipient and group dial, follow the procedure below.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.

5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the
Setup button.

6. Change the registered information.


• To change the recipient's information:
1. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.

2. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select a recipient's ID number, then press the
OK button.

3. Select Edit, then press the OK button.

The screen to select a registration method is displayed as well as when you register the
recipient.

4. Select a registration method, then press the OK button.


5. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number.
◦ From call log (OUT) is selected as the registration method:

The screen to select the fax/telephone number from the outgoing call logs is displayed.
After you use the button to select a fax/telephone number and press the OK button,
the editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number, then press
the OK button.
◦ From call log (IN) is selected as the registration method:

The screen to select the fax/telephone number or the name from the incoming call logs is
displayed. After you use the button to select a fax/telephone number or a name and
press the OK button, the editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone
number, then press the OK button.

276
Note
• This registration method may not be available depending on the country or region of
purchase.

◦ Direct entry is selected as the registration method:

The editing screen is displayed. Change the recipient's fax/telephone number, then press
the OK button.

Note
• You can enter the fax/telephone number up to 60 digits (40 digits for the US, Canada,
Korea and some regions of Latin America), including spaces.
Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

• Press the button twice to enter a pause.

• When Telephone line type in FAX user settings under Fax settings is set to Rotary
pulse, you can enter a tone ("T") by pressing the Tone button.

6. Change the recipient's name, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

• To change a group dial:

1. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.

2. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select an ID number of group dial to change,
then press the OK button.

3. Select Edit, then press the OK button.

4. Edit the member of the group dial.

To add a member, press the Menu/Wireless connect button to display the screen to select
an ID number and then add another member.

To delete a member, select a member to delete and then press the Tone button.
5. Change the group name, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can enter the name up to 16 characters, including spaces.

Entering Numbers, Letters, and Symbols

Note
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.

277
Deleting Registered Information

To delete information registered for recipient and group dial, follow the procedure below.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Directory, then press the OK button.

5. Select Add directory entry, then press the OK button.

Note
• You can select Add directory entry from TEL no. registration in Fax settings after pressing the
Setup button.

6. Delete the registered information.


• To delete the recipient's information:
1. Select Recipient, then press the OK button.

2. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select a recipient's ID number, then press the
OK button.

3. Select Delete, then press the OK button.

4. Select Yes, then press the OK button.

• To delete a group dial:


1. Select Group dial, then press the OK button.
2. Use the button or the Numeric buttons to select an ID number of group dial to delete,
then press the OK button.
3. Select Delete, then press the OK button.

4. Select Yes, then press the OK button.

Note
• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the FAX button.

278
Printing List of Registered Destinations

You can print a list of the fax/telephone numbers and can keep it near the printer to refer to when dialing.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load paper.

3. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

5. Select Print reports/lists, then press the OK button.

6. Select Directory list, then press the OK button.

7. Select an item to print, then press the OK button.


• If you selected Recipient:

The confirmation screen asking if you print the list alphabetically by name is displayed.

If you select Yes and press the OK button, RECIPIENT TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST is printed in
alphabetical order.

If you select No and press the OK button, RECIPIENT TELEPHONE NUMBER LIST is printed in
the order of the ID number.

• If you selected Group dial:

GROUP DIAL TELEPHONE NO. LIST is printed.

279
Registering Recipients Using Speed Dial Utility2 (macOS)

About Speed Dial Utility2


Speed Dial Utility2 is a utility for forwarding the telephone directory registered on the printer to a computer
and registering/changing it on the computer. In addition, you can register the telephone directory edited on
the computer to the printer. You can also save them on the computer as a backup.

For safety reasons, it is recommended that you backup the registered data on the computer using Speed
Dial Utility2.

Starting Up Speed Dial Utility2


Speed Dial Utility2 Dialog
Saving Registered Telephone Directory on Printer to Your Computer
Registering a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2
Changing a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2
Deleting a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2
Changing Sender Information Using Speed Dial Utility2
Registering/Changing Rejected Number Using Speed Dial Utility2
Registering Telephone Directory Has been Saved on Your Computer to Printer

280
Starting Up Speed Dial Utility2

Important
• Before starting up Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that the printer is connected to the computer correctly.
• Do not plug in or unplug any cables while the printer is in operation, or when the computer is in sleep or
standby mode.
• If your printer is compatible with LAN connection, make sure that the printer is connected to the
computer with LAN connection to use Speed Dial Utility2 via LAN connection.
• The password entry screen may appear during startup or operation. If it appears, enter the
administrator password, and then click OK. If you do not know the administrator password, contact the
administrator of the printer.

Follow the procedure below to start up Speed Dial Utility2.

1. Select Applications on Go menu of Finder.

2. Double-click Canon Utilities folder.

3. Double-click Speed Dial Utility2 folder.

4. Double-click Speed Dial Utility2.


Speed Dial Utility2 starts up.

Note
• You can also start up Speed Dial Utility2 from Quick Utility Toolbox.

281
Speed Dial Utility2 Dialog

The following items are on the Speed Dial Utility2 dialog.

1. Printer Name:
Selects the printer for editing the telephone directory using Speed Dial Utility2.

Behind printer name, printer's MAC address is displayed.

Note
• For checking printer's MAC address, refer to "Checking Network Information" for your model from
Home of the Online Manual.
• For printer that supports both wireless LAN connection and wired LAN connection, MAC address
of wired LAN connection is displayed regardless of the connection method.

2. Display Printer Settings


Loads the telephone directory registered on the printer that selected for Printer Name: into Speed Dial
Utility2.

3. Setting Item List:


Selects a setting item for editing. Choose one item from TEL Number Registration, User Information
Setting, and Rejected Number Setting.

4. Registered information list

282
Displays the registered information selected for Setting Item List:.

Note
• By clicking on the item name, you can sort the display order.

5. Edit.../Select All/Delete
Edits the item that selected for Setting Item List:, or deletes the item, or selects all the items.
When multiple items on the registered information list are selected, you cannot use the Edit... button.

6. Load from PC...


Displays the telephone directory saved on the computer.

7. Instructions
Displays this guide.

8. Exit
Quits Speed Dial Utility2. Information registered or edited using Speed Dial Utility2 is neither saved on
the computer nor registered on the printer.

9. Save to PC...
Saves the telephone directory edited using Speed Dial Utility2 on the computer.

10. Register to Printer


Registers the telephone directory edited using Speed Dial Utility2 to the printer.

283
Saving Registered Telephone Directory on Printer to Your
Computer

Follow the procedure below to save the telephone directory (includes recipients' name, recipients' fax/
telephone number, group dial, user's name, user's fax/telephone number, and rejected numbers) that
registered on the printer to the computer.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click Save to PC....

4. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.

Note
• The data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) can be imported to other printer.

Registering Telephone Directory Has been Saved on Your Computer to Printer

284
Registering a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2

Follow the procedure below to register fax/telephone numbers.

Note
Before you register fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations
are in progress.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.


The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.

4. Select an unoccupied code from list, and then click Edit....


The Individual or Group Selection dialog is displayed.

5. Click Register individual TEL number or Register group dial, and then click Next....
• If Register individual TEL number is selected:

1. Enter name.

2. Enter fax/telephone number.

• If Register group dial is selected:

1. Enter group name.

2. Select a code you want to add to group dial, and then click Add >>.

285
Note
• You can only add the numbers that have already been registered.

6. Click OK.
To continue registering fax/telephone numbers or a group dial, repeat steps 4 to 6.
• To save the registered information on the computer.

1. Click Save to PC....

2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.

• To register the registered information to the printer:


1. Click Register to Printer.
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.
The information is registered to the printer.

286
Changing a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2

Follow the procedure below to change fax/telephone numbers.

Note
• Before you change fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations
are in progress.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.


The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.

4. Select a code to change from list, and then click Edit....


• If an individual fax/telephone number is selected:

1. Enter a new name.

2. Enter a new fax/telephone number.


• If a group dial is selected:

1. Enter a new group name.


2. Add or delete a member to/from group dial.

To add a member:
Select a code to add to group dial, and then click Add >>.

287
To delete a member:
Select a code to delete from group dial, and then click << Delete.

5. Click OK.
To continue changing fax/telephone numbers or group dials, repeat steps 4 and 5.
• To save the edited information on the computer.
1. Click Save to PC....

2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.

• To register the edited information to the printer:


1. Click Register to Printer.
2. When message appears, check it and click OK.
The information is registered to the printer.

288
Deleting a Fax/telephone Number Using Speed Dial Utility2

Follow the procedure below to delete fax/telephone numbers.

Note
• Before you delete fax/telephone numbers using Speed Dial Utility2, make sure that no fax operations
are in progress.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click TEL Number Registration from Setting Item List:.


The list of registered fax/telephone numbers is displayed.

4. Select a code to delete from list, and then click Delete.

Note
• To delete all fax/telephone numbers on the list, click Select All, and then Delete.

5. When confirmation screen appears, click OK.


The selected fax/telephone number is deleted.

To continue deleting fax/telephone numbers, repeat steps 4 and 5.

• To save the edited information on the computer.

1. Click Save to PC....


2. Enter file name on the displayed screen, and then click Save.

• To register the edited information to the printer:


1. Click Register to Printer.

2. When message appears, check it and click OK.


The information is registered to the printer.

289
Changing Sender Information Using Speed Dial Utility2

Follow the procedure below to change the user's name or fax/telephone number.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click User Information Setting from Setting Item List:.


The user's information is displayed.

4. Select an item to change, and then click Edit....


The User Information dialog is displayed.

5. Enter new user's name on User Name and new fax/telephone number in TEL Number,
and then click OK.
• To save the edited information on the computer:

1. Click Save to PC....

2. Enter file name on displayed screen, and then click Save.

• To register the edited information to the printer:

1. Click Register to Printer.

2. When message appears, check it and click OK.

The information is registered to the printer.

290
Registering/Changing Rejected Number Using Speed Dial
Utility2

Follow the procedure below to register, change, or delete rejected numbers.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click Rejected Number Setting from Setting Item List:.


The list of rejected numbers is displayed.

• To register a rejected number:


1. Select an unoccupied code from list, and then click Edit....
2. Enter fax/telephone number in Rejected Number dialog, and then click OK.
• To change a rejected number:

1. Select a code to change from list, and then click Edit....

2. Enter fax/telephone number in Rejected Number dialog, and then click OK.

• To delete a rejected number:

1. Select a code to delete from list, and then click Delete.

The selected fax/telephone number is deleted.

Note
• To delete all fax/telephone numbers on the list, click Select All, and then Delete.

291
Registering Telephone Directory Has been Saved on Your
Computer to Printer

You can load the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) and register it to your printer.

The data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported from other printer can be loaded and
registered to your printer.

Note
• In Speed Dial Utility2, the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported using Speed
Dial Utility can be loaded.

1. Start up Speed Dial Utility2.

2. Select a printer from Printer Name: list box, and then click Display Printer Settings.

3. Click Load from PC....

4. Select a data of telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) to register to your printer.

5. Click Open on dialog.


The selected telephone directory is displayed.

Note
• If you select the data of the telephone directory (RSD file, *.rsd) that is exported from other printer,
the confirmation message appears. Click OK.

6. Click Register to Printer.


The telephone directory that has been saved on the computer is registered to your printer.

292
Sending Faxes Using Operation Panel of Printer

Sending Faxes by Entering Fax/Telephone Number Basic

Resending Faxes (Redialing Busy Number)

Setting Items for Sending Faxes

293
Sending Faxes by Entering Fax/Telephone Number

This section describes dialing and sending faxes directly by entering the fax/telephone numbers.

Important
• It may be possible that faxes will reach unintended recipients due to the misdialing or incorrect
registration of fax/telephone numbers. When you send important documents, we recommend that you
send them after speaking on the telephone.

Sending Fax after Speaking on Telephone

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Load documents on platen or in ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

Important
• When sending a double-sided document, load the document on the platen. Double-sided
documents cannot be automatically scanned and sent from the ADF.

Note
• For details on the types, conditions of document, and how to load the document:

Loading Originals

4. Adjust the scan contrast and resolution as necessary.


Setting Items for Sending Faxes

5. Use the Numeric buttons to dial the recipient's fax/telephone number.

Use the following buttons to dial the recipient's fax/telephone number.

Numeric buttons:
Enters the number.

button:
Enters a space.

button:
Deletes the last character you entered.

294
button:
By pressing this button once, "#" is entered. By pressing this button one more time, "P" is entered.

6. Press the Color button for color transmission, or the Black button for black & white
transmission.
The printer starts scanning the document.

Important
• Color transmission is available only when the recipient's fax device supports color faxing.
• Do not open the document cover until scanning is completed.

7. Start sending.

• If you load the document in the ADF:


The printer scans the document automatically and starts sending the fax.

Note
• To cancel a fax transmission, press the Stop button. To cancel a fax transmission while it is in
progress, press the Stop button, then follow the instructions on the LCD.

• If documents remain in the ADF after the Stop button is pressed while scanning is in progress,
Document in ADF [OK]Eject the document is displayed on the LCD. By pressing the OK
button, the remaining documents are automatically ejected.

• If you load the document on the platen:

After scanning the document, the confirmation screen asking you if you load the next document is
displayed.

To send the scanned document, press the OK button to start sending it.

To send two or more pages, follow the message to load the next page, and press the Color or
Black button. After scanning all pages, press the OK button to start sending.

Note
• To cancel sending the fax, press the Stop button.

Note
• When your printer is connected to a PBX (Private Branch Exchange) system, refer to the operating
instructions of the system for details on dialing the recipient's fax/telephone number.

• In case the printer was not able to send a fax, such as when the recipient's line was busy, it has the
function to automatically redial the number after a specified interval. Automatic redialing is enabled by
default.

Automatic Redialing

• Unsent documents, such as those pending redial, are stored in the printer's memory. They are not
stored in the case of a sending error.

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

295
• Do not unplug the power cord until all documents are sent. If you unplug the power cord, all unsent
documents stored in the printer's memory are lost.

296
Resending Faxes (Redialing Busy Number)

There are two methods of redialing: Automatic redialing and Manual redialing.

• Automatic Redialing
If you send a document and the recipient's line is busy, the printer will redial the number after a specified
interval.

Automatic Redialing

• Manual Redialing

You can redial to the recipients dialed using the Numeric buttons.

Manual Redialing

Important
• It may be possible that faxes will reach unintended recipients due to the misdialing or incorrect
registration of fax/telephone numbers. When you send important documents, we recommend that you
send them after speaking on the telephone.

Sending Fax after Speaking on Telephone

Note
• Automatic redialing is enabled by default.

• For details on the basic sending operations:

Sending Faxes by Entering Fax/Telephone Number

Automatic Redialing
You can enable or disable automatic redialing. If you enable automatic redialing, you can specify the
maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the printer waits between redial attempts.

Enable and specify the automatic redialing setting on Auto redial in Adv. FAX settings under Fax
settings.
Adv. FAX settings

Important
• While automatic redialing, the unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory temporarily until the
sending fax is complete. If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord before automatic
redialing is complete, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted and not sent.

Note
• To stop automatic redialing, wait until the printer starts redialing, then press the Stop button.

• To cancel automatic redialing, delete the unsent fax from the printer's memory while the printer is on-
standby for a redial operation. For details, see Deleting Document in Printer's Memory.

297
Manual Redialing
Follow the procedure below for manual redialing.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Load documents on platen or in ADF (Auto Document Feeder).

4. Adjust the scan contrast and resolution as necessary.


Setting Items for Sending Faxes

5. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

6. Select Redial, then press the OK button.

7. Select the recipient's number to redial, then press the OK button.

8. Press the Color button for color transmission, or the Black button for black & white
transmission.

Important
• Color transmission is available only when the recipient's fax device supports color faxing.

Note
• For manual redialing, the printer memorizes up to 10 recent recipients dialed by entering the fax/
telephone numbers. Note that the printer does not memorize any recipients dialed using the redial
function or selecting from the directory.

• To cancel manual redialing, press the Stop button. To cancel a fax transmission while it is in
progress, press the Stop button, then follow the instructions on the LCD.

• If documents remain in the ADF after the Stop button is pressed while scanning is in progress,
Document in ADF [OK]Eject the document is displayed on the LCD. By pressing the OK button,
the remaining documents are automatically ejected.

298
Setting Items for Sending Faxes

If you select FAX TX settings after pressing the Menu/Wireless connect button on the Fax standby
screen, you can specify the settings of the scan contrast and the scan resolution.

Adjust the scan contrast and resolution following the procedure below.

1. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button on the Fax standby screen.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

2. Select FAX TX settings, then press the OK button.

3. Select Scan contrast, then press the OK button.

4. Select the scan contrast, then press the OK button.

The button decreases the scan contrast, and the button increases the scan contrast.

5. Select Scan resolution, then press the OK button.

6. Select the scan resolution.

Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

Standard
Suitable for text-only documents.
Fine
Suitable for fine-print documents.

Extra fine
Suitable for detailed illustration or fine-print quality documents.

If the recipient's fax device is not compatible with Extra fine (300 x 300 dpi), the fax will be sent in
the Standard or Fine resolution.

Photo
Suitable for photographs.

299
Note
• When sending a color fax, documents are always scanned in the same resolution (200 x 200 dpi).
The image quality (compression rate) is determined by which scan resolution is selected, except
that Extra fine and Photo provide the same image quality.

7. Press the OK button.


The LCD returns to the Fax standby screen.

300
Sending Faxes from Computer (Mac OS)

Sending Faxes Using AirPrint

General Notes (Fax Transmission Using AirPrint)

301
Sending Faxes Using AirPrint

You can send faxes from a printer using AirPrint.

To send faxes, add your printer to your computer.

Checking Environment
First, check your environment.

• AirPrint operation environment

A computer running Mac OS.

Note
• For supported operating system versions, click Home to return to the top page of the Online
Manual for your model and search for "Specifications."

• Requirement

The computer and your printer must be connected correctly.

Adding Printer to Computer

1. Open System Preferences and select Printers & Scanners (Print & Scan).

2. Click + to display printer list.

3. Select printer model name with Bonjour Multifunction displayed.

Note
• If the printer does not appear, check the following.
• The printer is turned on.
• The firewall function of the security software is off.
• The printer is connected to the access point or directly connected to the computer.
• If using the printer with USB connection, select USB Multifunction.

4. Select Secure AirPrint or AirPrint from Use.

5. Click Add.

Sending Fax
Note
• Only black and white transmission is supported.

302
1. Make sure printer is on.

2. In application, open document to fax.

3. Open Print dialog.


To open the Print dialog, you typically select Print... from the File menu of your application software.

4. Select Canon XXX series - Fax (where "XXX" is the model name) from Printer list.

5. Specify fax paper settings as needed.

303
6. Enter fax/telephone numbers in To.

304
If you specify a dialing prefix, enter the code in Dialing Prefix and specify the cover page settings as
needed.

7. Click Fax.
The number is dialed automatically and the fax is sent.

Note
• To cancel sending the fax, press the printer's Stop button.

Automatic Redialing
If the fax could not be sent (for example, when the recipient was busy), the number is redialed
automatically according to the automatic redialing setting of the printer.

You can enable or disable automatic redialing. If you enable automatic redialing, you can specify the
maximum number of redial attempts and the length of time the printer waits between redial attempts.

Note
• To cancel automatic redialing, wait until redialing starts, and then press the printer's Stop button.
• For more details, click Home to return to the top page of the Online Manual for your model and
search for "FAX settings."

305
General Notes (Fax Transmission Using AirPrint)

Sending faxes is subject to the following restrictions.

• Enter the characters in To and Dialing Prefix so that the total number of characters is within 40
characters.
• You can use the following characters for To:

Character Explanation

0-9*# For use in telephone and fax numbers.

+ space To make the number easier to read. You cannot insert a space at the front of a number.

• You can use the following characters for Dialing Prefix:

Character Explanation

0-9*# For use in telephone and fax numbers.

p To place a pause between numbers.

T Numbers after the T will be sent as a tone signal.

+ space To make the number easier to read. You cannot insert a space at the front of a number.

306
Receiving Faxes

Receiving Faxes

Changing Paper Settings

Memory Reception

307
Receiving Faxes

This section describes the preparation necessary for receiving a fax and how to receive a fax.

Preparing for Receiving a Fax


Prepare for receiving a fax according to the following procedure.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Make sure of the receive mode setting.


Make sure of the receive mode setting displayed on the Fax standby screen.

Note
• For details on how to change the receive mode:

Setting Receive Mode

4. Load paper.
Load the sheets of plain paper.

5. Specify the paper settings as necessary.


Changing Paper Settings

This completes the preparation for receiving fax.

When a fax is received, it is printed on the loaded paper automatically.

Receiving a Fax
Depending on the selected receive mode, the receive operation varies.

Note
• For details on the receive mode:

Setting Receive Mode

• You can specify the advanced settings of each receive mode.

For details on the advanced settings of the receive mode:

Advanced Settings of Receive Mode

308
• If the printer was not able to print a received fax, the printer stores the unprinted fax in its memory
(Substitute Reception).

Memory Reception

When TEL priority mode is selected:

• When the call is a fax:


The telephone will ring when a call incomes.

Pick up the handset. If you hear the fax tone, wait for at least 5 seconds after it stops, then hang up
the handset.

The printer will receive the fax.

Note
• If the printer will not switch to fax reception, press the FAX button, then the Color or Black
button to receive the fax.

• To receive a fax without picking up the handset, set Manual/auto switch of the advanced
setting to ON. RX start time allows you to specify the number of seconds until the printer
switches to fax reception.
• If you have subscribed to Duplex Ringing service in Hong Kong, the telephone will ring a
specified number of times when there is an incoming call with a fax distinctive ring pattern.
Then, the printer will switch to fax reception automatically without the handset being picked up.

The number of times to ring the telephone until switching to fax reception can be changed.
• Set the printer to enable you to initiate fax reception from a connected telephone (remote
reception).

Remote Reception

• When the answering machine is connected to the printer:

• If the answering machine is set to the answering mode, set User-friendly RX of the
advanced setting to ON. If the call is a fax, the printer will receive the fax automatically.

309
• If the answering mode is turned off on the answering machine, pick up the handset. If you
hear the fax tone, wait for at least 5 seconds after it stops, then hang up the handset.

• If Manual/auto switch of the advanced setting is set to ON, set RX start time to longer
than the time before the answering machine starts playing the answering message. After
making this setting, we recommend that you call the answering machine using a mobile
phone, etc. to confirm that messages are recorded successfully in the answering machine.

• Set your answering machine to answering mode and adjust it as follows:

• The entire message should be no longer than 15 seconds.

• In the message, tell your callers how to send a fax.

• When the call is a voice call:


The telephone will ring when a call incomes.

Pick up the handset, and talk on the telephone.

Note
• If the printer unexpectedly switches to fax reception during telephone calls, set User-friendly
RX of the advanced setting to OFF.
• If Manual/auto switch of the advanced setting is set to ON, you must answer an incoming call
by picking up the handset within the time specified in RX start time. Otherwise the printer will
switch to fax reception.

When Fax only mode is selected:

• When the call is a fax:

The printer will receive the fax automatically.

Note
• If a telephone is connected to the printer, the telephone will ring when a call incomes.

310
• You can change the number of times to ring the telephone with Incoming ring of the advanced
setting.

When DRPD or Network switch is selected:

• When the call is a fax:


The telephone will ring when a call incomes.

The printer will receive the fax automatically when the fax ring pattern is detected.

Note
• You can change the number of times to ring the telephone.
Advanced Settings of Receive Mode

• When the call is a voice call:


The telephone will ring when a call incomes.

When the printer does not detect the fax ring pattern, the telephone will continue ringing.

Pick up the handset, and talk on the telephone.

Note
• To use this feature, you need to subscribe to a compatible service provided by your telephone
company.

• For DRPD

You need to select the appropriate ring pattern on the printer.

Setting the DRPD Ring Pattern (US and Canada only)

311
• For Network switch
The name of this service varies depending on the country or region of purchase. This setting
may not be also available depending on the country or region of purchase.

312
Changing Paper Settings

This printer prints received faxes to paper loaded in the printer beforehand. You can use the operation panel
to change the paper settings for printing faxes. Make sure that the settings are appropriate for the loaded
paper.

Important
• If the size of loaded paper is different from that specified in the paper size setting, Check page size
Press [OK] are displayed on the LCD. In this case, load the same size of paper as that specified in the
paper size setting, then press the OK button.

You can also press the Stop button to close the message and print the stored documents in the
printer's memory later.

Printing Document in Printer's Memory

• If no paper is loaded, or paper has run out while printing is in progress, the error message for no paper
is displayed on the LCD. In this case, load paper and press the OK button.

You can also press the Stop button to close the message and print the stored documents in the
printer's memory later.

Printing Document in Printer's Memory

Note
• If the sender sends a document that is larger than Letter-size or Legal-size, such as 11 x 17 inches, the
sender's printer may send the fax automatically reduced in size or divided, or send only a part of the
original.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select FAX paper settings, then press the OK button.

5. Select a setting item, then press the OK button.

6. Specify the settings.


Use the button to adjust each setting item, then press the OK button. The next setting item is
displayed.

The LCD returns to the Fax standby screen when all the settings are complete or when pressing the
FAX button.

313
Note
• The (asterisk) on the LCD indicates the current setting.

Page size
Select the page size from A4, Letter, or Legal.
Note
• Some of page sizes are not available depending on the country or region of purchase.

Media type
The paper type is set to Plain paper.
2-sided
Select whether to perform two-sided printing when printing faxes, reports, or lists.

314
Memory Reception

If the printer was not able to print the received fax, the received fax is stored in the printer's memory. The
FAX Memory lamp is lit and Received in memory is displayed at the Fax standby screen.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted. The next time you
turn the printer on, press the OK button after a confirmation screen is displayed. The list of the faxes
deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed.

If the printer receives a fax under one of the following conditions, the received fax will be automatically
stored in the printer's memory.

• The printer is set to store received faxes in its memory:

When Do not print is selected for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings,
the received faxes are stored in the printer's memory.

You can print the faxes stored in the printer's memory from Memory reference in the FAX menu
screen.

Printing Document in Printer's Memory

Note
• To print the received faxes automatically, select Print for Received documents in Auto print
settings under FAX settings.

Auto print settings

• An error has occurred on the printer:

If you select Print for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings, a received fax
will be printed automatically. However, if any of the following errors occurs, the received fax will not be
printed. It will instead be stored in the printer's memory.

When the error is resolved, the fax stored in the printer's memory is printed automatically.
◦ The amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print a fax:

Replace the FINE cartridge.

Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Note
• You can set the printer to forcibly print a received fax even if the ink has run out.

Set Print when no ink in Auto print settings under FAX settings to Print.

However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.

Also, the contents of the fax will not be stored in the printer's memory.

If the ink has already run out, we recommend that Do not print be selected for Received
documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings to store the received fax in the printer's
memory. After you replace the FINE cartridge and select Print for Received documents in
Auto print settings, the fax stored in the printer's memory will be printed automatically.

315
Auto print settings

◦ Paper has run out:


Load the paper and press the OK button.

◦ A different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings is loaded:
Load the same size of paper as that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings, and then press
the OK button.

• You pressed the Stop button to cancel printing of a fax:

To resume printing of the fax, display the Fax standby screen by pressing the FAX button again.

Note
• The printer can store up to max. 50 pages* (max. 20 documents) of faxes in the printer's memory.

* When using ITU-T No.1 chart (Standard mode)

• If the printer's memory becomes full during memory reception, only pages which already have been
received are stored in the memory. Print the received faxes stored in the printer's memory, and then
delete them from the printer's memory and have the sender resend the faxes.

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

316
Other Useful Fax Functions

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

317
Document Stored in Printer's Memory

If the sending faxes is not complete or the printer was not able to print the received faxes, these faxes are
stored in the printer's memory.

If an error occurred during a fax transmission, the document is not stored in the printer's memory.

In the following cases, the printer is not able to print the received fax and will automatically store the fax in
its memory.

• The amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print a fax.

• Paper has run out.

• A different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper settings is loaded.
• Do not print is selected for Received documents in Auto print settings under FAX settings.

• You pressed the Stop button to cancel printing of a received fax.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord of the printer, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

For details on how to unplug the power cord, refer to Unplugging the Printer.

You can print or delete the faxes stored in the printer's memory.
• To print a document in the printer's memory:

Printing Document in Printer's Memory


• To delete a document in the printer's memory:

Deleting Document in Printer's Memory

Note
• When confirming, printing, or deleting a document stored in the printer's memory, you specify it by its
transaction number. If you do not know the transaction number for your target document, print the list of
documents (MEMORY LIST) first.

For details on how to print MEMORY LIST, see Printing Document in Printer's Memory.

318
Printing Document in Printer's Memory

You can print a specified document in the printer's memory or print all the received documents in its memory
at a time.

When printing a specified document, you specify it by its transaction number. If you do not know the
transaction number for your target document, print the list of documents (MEMORY LIST) first.

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Load paper.

3. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

4. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

5. Select Memory reference, then press the OK button.

Note
• If no document is stored in the printer's memory, No documents in memory is displayed on the
LCD.

6. Select a print menu, then press the OK button.


Print memory list
You can print a list of the documents in the printer's memory (MEMORY LIST).

MEMORY LIST shows the transaction number of the unsent or unprinted fax (TX/RX NO.),
transaction mode, recipient's number, and the date and time of the transaction.

A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" on MEMORY LIST indicates a document being sent. A
transaction number from "5001" to "9999" on MEMORY LIST indicates a document being received.
Print specified doc.
You can specify the document and print it.

If you select this menu, the document selection screen is displayed.

Note
• A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" indicates a document being sent. A transaction
number from "5001" to "9999" indicates a document being received.
• Each mark before the transaction number indicates the following:

No mark: Indicates a black and white document.

319
: Indicates a color document.

: Indicates the document during transmission.

: Indicates the document sent with sequential broadcasting.

• By pressing the button or the Tone button, the transaction number displayed on the LCD
is switched to transaction time or fax/telephone number.

Specify the document and print it following the procedure below.


1. Select the transaction number (TX/RX no.) of the document you want to print, then press the
OK button.

2. Select whether to print only the first page of the document, then press the OK button.
• If you select Yes:
Only the first page of the document will be printed.
The document is still stored in the printer's memory.

• If you select No:

All pages of the document will be printed.

The screen to confirm whether to delete the printed document in the printer's memory is
displayed.

If you select Yes and press the OK button, the printed document in the printer's memory is
deleted.

Note
• If there is not the specified document in the printer's memory, No document is displayed,
and the printer returns to the previous screen.

• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the Stop button.

Print all RX docs


If you select this menu, the confirmation screen is displayed.

You can print all the received documents in the printer's memory.

If you select Yes and press the OK button, all the documents in the printer's memory will be printed.
Each time a document is printed, the screen to confirm whether to delete the printed document in
the printer's memory is displayed.

If you select Yes and press the OK button, the printed document in the printer's memory is deleted.

320
Deleting Document in Printer's Memory

You can delete a specified document in the printer's memory or delete all the documents in its memory at a
time.

Note
• When deleting a specified document, you specify it by its transaction number (TX/RX no.). If you do not
know the transaction number for your target document, print the list of documents (MEMORY LIST)
first.

Printing Document in Printer's Memory

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the FAX button.


The Fax standby screen is displayed.

3. Press the Menu/Wireless connect button.


The FAX menu screen is displayed.

4. Select Memory reference, then press the OK button.

Note
• If no document is stored in the printer's memory, No documents in memory is displayed on the
LCD.

5. Select a delete menu, then press the OK button.


Del. specified doc.
You can specify the document and delete it.

If you select this menu, the document selection screen is displayed.

Note
• A transaction number from "0001" to "4999" indicates a document being sent. A transaction
number from "5001" to "9999" indicates a document being received.
• Each mark before the transaction number indicates the following:

No mark: Indicates a black and white document.

: Indicates a color document.

: Indicates the document during transmission.

: Indicates the document sent with sequential broadcasting.

321
• By pressing the button or the Tone button, the transaction number displayed on the LCD
is switched to transaction time or fax/telephone number.

Specify the document and delete it following the procedure below.


1. Select the transaction number (TX/RX no.) of the document you want to delete, then press the
OK button.
The confirmation screen is displayed.

2. Select Yes, then press the OK button.

The specified document will be deleted from printer's memory.

Note
• If there is not the specified document in the printer's memory, No document is displayed,
and the printer returns to the previous screen.

• To return to the Fax standby screen, press the Stop button.

Delete all docs


If you select this menu, the confirmation screen is displayed.

You can delete all the documents in the printer's memory.

If you select Yes and press the OK button, all the documents in the printer's memory will be deleted.

322
Frequently Asked Questions

Cannot Find Printer on Network


Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi
Network Key (Password) Unknown
Network
Cannot Print or Connect

For other questions about network, click here.

Printer Does Not Print


Printouts Are Blank/Blurry or Fuzzy/Inaccurate or Bleeding Colors/Streaks or Lines
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory
Print
List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams)
Cannot Print or Connect

Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows)

Installation

Cannot Send a Fax


Cannot Receive a Fax, Cannot Print a Fax
FAX Setup Guide
Fax

An Error Occurs
Message (Support Code) Appears

Error

Solve Problems

Printer Does Not Work


Printer Does Not Turn On
Printer Turns Off Unexpectedly or Repeatedly
Wrong Language Appears in LCD
LCD Is Off
USB Connection Problems
Cannot Communicate with Printer via USB
Printer Does Not Print
Copying/Printing Stops
Cannot Print Using AirPrint
Printer Prints Slowly
Ink Does Not Come Out

323
List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams)
Paper Does Not Feed Properly/"No Paper" Error
Automatic Duplex Printing Problems
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory
Scanning Problems (Windows)
Scanning Problems (macOS)
Scan Results Are Unsatisfactory (Windows)
Scan Results Are Unsatisfactory (macOS)
Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet

Cannot Set Correctly (Network)


Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Setup (Windows)
Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi
Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason
Network Key (Password) Unknown
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer
Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or Changed Router Settings
Message Appears on Computer During Setup
Checking Network Information
Restoring to Factory Defaults

Cannot Set Correctly (Installation)


Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows)
Easy-WebPrint EX Does Not Start or Easy-WebPrint EX Menu Does Not Appear (Windows)
Updating MP Drivers in Network Environment (Windows)

Error or Message Appears


An Error Occurs
Message (Support Code) Appears
A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD
List of Support Code for Error
IJ Scan Utility Error Messages (Windows)
IJ Scan Utility Lite Error Messages (macOS)
ScanGear (Scanner Driver) Error Messages (Windows)

Operation Problems

Network Communication Problems


Printing Problems
Problems while Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet
Scanning Problems (Windows)
Scanning Problems (macOS)
Faxing Problems
Mechanical Problems
Installation and Download Problems
Errors and Messages
If You Cannot Solve a Problem

324
Network Settings and Common Problems

Here are frequently asked questions on network. Select a connection method you are using, or you want to
use.

Wireless LAN Wireless Direct

Wireless LAN

Cannot Find Printer


Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Setup (Windows)
Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen
Printer Is Not Found by Printer Find Screen of Setup
Searching Printer by IP Address or Host Name During Setup
Error Occurs During Wi-Fi Setup
Detect Same Printer Name
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection

Cannot Print or Connect


Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason
Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or Changed Router Settings
Cannot Access to Internet on Wi-Fi from Communication Device
Connecting Printer and Wireless Router Using Easy wireless connect
Cannot Connect Smartphone/Tablet to Wireless Router
Error Occurs During Wi-Fi Setup
Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN Connection
Cannot Print or Connect

LAN Setting Tips/Changing LAN Settings


Network Key (Password) Unknown
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer
Checking Network Information
Restoring to Factory Defaults
Checking Wireless Router SSID/Key
Checking Wireless Router Network Name (SSID) for Smartphone/Tablet
Privacy Separator/SSID Separator/Network Separation Function
Default Network Settings
Connects to Another Computer via LAN/Changes from USB to LAN Connection
Printing Network Settings
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection
Checking Status Code

325
Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet
Connecting Printer and Wireless Router Using Easy wireless connect
Cannot Connect Smartphone/Tablet to Wireless Router
Checking Wireless Router Network Name (SSID) for Smartphone/Tablet
Setting Up Using Smartphone/Tablet
Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet
Downloading Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY

Problems while Using Printer


Message Appears on Computer During Setup
Printer Prints Slowly
No Ink Level Appears in Printer Status Monitor (Windows)
Packets Are Sent Constantly (Windows)

Wireless Direct

Cannot Print or Connect


Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason
Cannot Access to Internet on Wi-Fi from Communication Device
Cannot Print or Connect

LAN Setting Tips/Changing LAN Settings


Network Key (Password) Unknown
Forgot Administrator Password of Printer
Checking Network Information
Restoring to Factory Defaults
Default Network Settings
Printing Network Settings
Reconfiguration Method of Wi-Fi Connection
Checking Status Code

Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet


Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet
Downloading Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY

Problems while Using Printer


Message Appears on Computer During Setup
Printer Prints Slowly
No Ink Level Appears in Printer Status Monitor (Windows)

326
Network Communication Problems

Cannot Find Printer on Network

Network Connection Problems

Other Network Problems

327
Cannot Find Printer on Network

While performing printer setup:


Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Setup
(Windows)

Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen

While using printer:


Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi

328
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During
Setup (Windows)

If the printer cannot be found and the Check Printer Settings screen appears after searching the printer by
Automatic search on the Search for Printers screen, click Redetect and search for the printer again by
the IP address on the Search for Printers screen.

If the printer has not been found after searching it by the IP address, check network settings.

Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking Power
Status
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking PC
Network Connection
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's Wi-Fi Settings
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking Wi-Fi
Environment
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's IP Address
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Security Software Settings
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Wireless Router Settings

329
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Power Status

Are printer and network device (router, etc.) turned on?


Make sure the printer is turned on.

Checking that Power Is On

Make sure network device (router, etc.) is turned on.

If printer or network device is off:


Turn on printer or network device.

It may take a while for the printer and network device to become ready for use once they are turned on.
Wait a while after turning on the printer or network device, and then click Redetect on the Check Printer
Settings screen to redetect the printer.

If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.

If printer and network device are on:


If the network devices are on, turn them off and on again.

If above does not solve the problem:


Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking PC
Network Connection

330
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking PC Network Connection

Can you view any web pages on your computer?


Make sure the computer and network device (router, etc.) are configured and the computer is connected
to the network.

If you cannot view any web pages:


Click Cancel on the Check Printer Settings screen to cancel to set up the network communication.

After that, configure the computer and network device.

For the procedures, refer to the instruction manuals supplied with the computer and network device, or
contact their manufacturers.

If you can view web pages after configuring the computer and network device, try to set up the network
communication from the beginning.

If above does not solve the problem:


Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's Wi-Fi Settings

331
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Printer's Wi-Fi Settings

Is printer set to allow wireless communication?


Make sure the or icon is displayed on the LCD.

If icon is not displayed:


The printer is not set to allow wireless communication. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.

If icon is displayed:
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking Wi-Fi
Environment

332
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Wi-Fi Environment

Is the printer connected to the wireless router?


Use the icon on the LCD to make sure the printer is connected to the wireless router.

If is displayed:
• Check wireless router configuration.

After checking the wireless router setting, make sure the printer is not placed far away from the
wireless router.

The printer can be up to 50 m (164 ft) from the wireless router indoors. Make sure the printer is close
enough to the wireless router to be used.

Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless
communication between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be
impeded by building materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with
the computer over a Wi-Fi due to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.

In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth
as a wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from
interference sources as possible.

Note
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.

• Check wireless router setting.

The printer and wireless router should be connected using 2.4 GHz bandwidth. Make sure the
wireless router for the printer's destination is configured to use 2.4 GHz bandwidth.

Important
• Note that some wireless routers distinguish network names (SSIDs) by the last alphanumeric
character according to their bandwidth (2.4 GHz or 5 GHz) or purpose (for computer or game
machine).

To check the network name (SSID) of the wireless router the printer is connected to, print the network
settings.

Printing Network Settings

333
For details, see the instruction manual supplied with the wireless router or contact the manufacturer.
After taking measures above, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to redetect the
printer.

If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.

If the printer cannot be detected, the printer is not connected to the wireless router. Connect the printer to
the wireless router.

After connecting the printer to the wireless router, set up the network communication from the beginning.

If is displayed:
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Printer's IP Address

334
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Printer's IP Address

Is printer's IP address specified correctly?


If printer's IP address is not specified correctly, the printer may not be found. Make sure whether printer's
IP address is not used for another device.

To check the printer's IP address, print out the network settings information.

Printing Network Settings

If the IP address is not specified correctly:


See If an error screen appears: and specify the IP address.

If the IP address is specified correctly:


Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Security Software Settings

335
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Security Software Settings

Disable block in firewall function temporarily.


The firewall of your security software or operation system for computer may limit communication between
the printer and your computer. Check the firewall setting of your security software or operation system or
the message shown on your computer and disable block temporarily.

If firewall interferes with setup:


• If message appears:

If a message appears warning that Canon software is attempting to access the network, set the
security software to allow access.

After allowing the software to access, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to
redetect the printer.

If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network
communication.

• If no message appears:

Cancel the setup, and then set the security software to allow Canon software to access the network.

The file Setup.exe or Setup64.exe in the win > Driver > DrvSetup folder on the Setup CD-ROM

After setting the security software, redo the network communication setup from the beginning.

After setup is completed, enable firewall.

Note
• For more on firewall settings of your operating system or security software, see instruction manual or
contact its manufacturer.

If above does not solve the problem:

Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi Setup (Windows)-Checking
Wireless Router Settings

336
Cannot Find Printer on Check Printer Settings Screen During Wi-Fi
Setup (Windows)-Checking Wireless Router Settings

Check wireless router settings.


Check wireless router network connection settings, such as IP address filtering, MAC address filtering,
encryption key, and DHCP function.

Make sure the same radio channel is assigned to the printer and the wireless router.

To check the settings of the wireless router, see the instruction manual supplied with the wireless router or
contact the manufacturer.

In addition, make sure the wireless router you are using is configured to use 2.4 GHz bandwidth.

Important
• Depending on the wireless router, note that different network name (SSID) is assigned for a
bandwidth (2.4 GHz or 5 GHz) or its usage (for PC or game machine) using alphanumeric characters
at the end of network name (SSID).

After checking the wireless router settings, click Redetect on the Check Printer Settings screen to
redetect the printer.

If the printer is found, follow the instructions on the screen to continue to set up network communication.

337
Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen

If you cannot proceed beyond the Printer Connection screen, check the following.

Check1 Make sure USB cable is securely plugged in to printer and computer.
Connect the printer and the computer using a USB cable as the illustration below. The USB port is located at the
back of the printer.

Important
• Connect the "Type-B" terminal to the printer with the notched side facing UP. For details, refer to the
instruction manual supplied with the USB cable.

Check2 Follow procedure below to connect printer and computer again.


Important
• For macOS, make sure the lock icon is on the lower left of the Printers & Scanners screen.

If the icon (locked) is displayed, click the icon to unlock. (The administrator name and the password
are necessary to unlock.)

1. Unplug USB cable from printer and computer and connect it again.

2. Make sure no printer operation is in progress and turn off.

3. Turn on printer.

Check3 If you cannot resolve problem, follow procedure below to reinstall MP Drivers.
• For Windows:

1. Click Cancel.

2. Click Back to Top on Setup Canceled screen.

3. Click Exit on Start Setup screen and finish setup.

338
4. Turn off printer.

5. Restart computer.

6. Make sure you have no application software running.

7. Perform setup on web page.

Note
• You can use the Setup CD-ROM to redo setup.

• For macOS:

1. Click Next.
The screen telling you that installation has not been completed appears.

2. Click No.
The screen to select application software to install appears.

3. Click Back to Top.

4. Click Exit on Start Setup screen.

5. Turn off printer.

6. Restart computer.

7. Make sure you have no application software running.

8. Perform setup on web page.

339
Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi

Check1 Make sure printer is turned on.


If not, make sure the printer is securely plugged in and press ON button to turn on.

The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.

Check2 Check the icon on LCD .

The icon appears when you switch a mode by pressing the SCAN button or Setup button.
If the icon is not displayed, select Active for Enable/disab. Wi-Fi in Wi-Fi under LAN settings under Device
settings from the setup menu.

If the icon is displayed, see Check 3 or later checking items to make sure whether printer setup is
complete or the settings of wireless router to connect are correct.

Check3 Make sure printer setup is complete on the computer.


If it is not, perform setup.

• For Windows:
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

• For macOS:
Perform setup from the web page.

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status. Download it from the
web page.
For Windows
For macOS

Check4 Make sure printer and wireless router network settings match.
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are
identical with those of the wireless router.

To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its
manufacturer.

Note
• Use 2.4 GHz frequency band to connect to a wireless router. Match the network name (SSID) set for the
printer with that for 2.4 GHz frequency band of the wireless router.

To check the network name (SSID) set for the printer, print out the network setting information.

340
Printing Network Settings

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.
Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.


• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility


• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Check5 Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place
the printer and wireless router close to each other.

Note
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.

Check6 Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal strength and move printer
and wireless router as necessary.
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due to
a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference
sources as possible.
Check the signal strength on the LCD.
LCD and Operation Panel

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

341
Check7 Make sure the computer is connected to the wireless router.
For more on how to check the computer settings or connection status, see your computer instruction manual or
contact its manufacturer.

Note
• If you use a smartphone or tablet, make sure the Wi-Fi is enabled on the device.

Check8 Make sure Enable bidirectional support is selected in the Ports sheet of the
properties dialog box of the printer driver. (Windows)
If not, select it to enable bidirectional support.

Check9 Make sure security software's firewall is off.


If your security software's firewall is on, a message may appear warning you that Canon software is attempting
to access the network. If this warning message appears, set security software to always allow access.
If you are using any programs that switch between network environments, check their settings. Some programs
use a firewall by default.

Check10 If printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN, make sure you use
alphanumeric characters for network name (SSID). (macOS)

If the problem is not resolved, redo setup.

• For Windows:

Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

• For macOS:

Perform setup from the web page.

342
Network Connection Problems

Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason

Network Key (Password) Unknown

Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or Changed Router


Settings

343
Printer Suddenly Stopped Working for Some Reason

Cannot Connect to a Printer after Network Configuration Changes


Cannot Connect to a Printer via Wireless LAN (Wi-Fi)
Cannot Connect to a Printer through Wireless Direct
Cannot Print/Scan/Fax through Network

Cannot Connect to a Printer after Network Configuration Changes

It may take a while for the computer to obtain an IP address, or you may need to restart your computer.

Make sure the computer has obtained a valid IP address, and try again to find the printer.

Cannot Connect to a Printer via Wireless LAN (Wi-Fi)

Check1 Check the power status of printer, network devices (e.g. wireless router), and
smartphone/tablet.
• Turn on the printer or devices.
• If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.
• It may be necessary to resolve wireless router problems (e.g. update interval of a key, problems of DHCP
update interval, energy saving mode, etc.) or to update the wireless router firmware.

For details, contact the manufacturer of your wireless router.

Check2 Can you view any web pages on your computer?


Make sure your computer is connected to the wireless router properly.
For more on checking computer settings or connection status, see the instruction manual supplied with the
computer or contact the manufacturer.

Check3 Is the printer connected to the wireless router?

Use the icon on the LCD to check the connection status between the printer and wireless router. If the
icon is not displayed, Wi-Fi is disabled. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.

Check4 Make sure the printer and wireless router network settings match.
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are
identical with those of the wireless router.

To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its
manufacturer.

344
Note
• Use 2.4 GHz frequency band to connect to a wireless router. Match the network name (SSID) set for the
printer with that for 2.4 GHz frequency band of the wireless router.

To check the current network settings of the printer, print out the network setting information.

Printing Network Settings

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility


• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Check5 Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place
the printer and wireless router close to each other.

Note
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.

Check6 Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal status and move printer
and wireless router as necessary.
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due
to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.
In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference
sources as possible.

Check the signal strength on the LCD.

LCD and Operation Panel

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:

345
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Check7 Make sure of the Wi-Fi channel numbers used for your computer.
You need to have the same Wi-Fi channel number that you are using for the wireless router as your computer.
It is normally set in the way that you can use all the Wi-Fi channels. However, when the channels that you are
using are restricted, the Wi-Fi channels do not match.

See the instruction manual provided with your computer and check the Wi-Fi channel number available for
your computer.

Check8 Make sure channel set on wireless router is a usable channel as confirmed in
Check 7.
If it is not, change the channel set on the wireless router.

Check9 Make sure security software's firewall is off.


If your security software's firewall is on, a message may appear warning you that Canon software is attempting
to access the network. If this warning message appears, set security software to always allow access.
If you are using any programs that switch between network environments, check their settings. Some
programs use a firewall by default.

Check10 If printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN, make sure you
use alphanumeric characters for network name (SSID). (macOS)

If the problem is not resolved, redo setup.

• For Windows:

Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

• For macOS:

Perform setup from the web page.

• Positioning:

Make sure there are no obstacles between the printer and the wireless router.

Cannot Connect to a Printer through Wireless Direct

Check1 Check the power status of printer and other devices (smartphone or tablet).
Turn on the printer or devices.

If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.

346
Check2 Check printer settings.
Select LAN settings > Wireless Direct > Switch WL Direct in this order and select Yes.

Check3 Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).


Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.

Check4 Make sure printer is selected as connection for device (e.g. smartphone or
tablet).
Select the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer as the connection destination for
devices.
Check the destination on your device.

For details, refer to your device's instruction manual or visit the manufacturer's website.

To check the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer, print out the network setting
information of the printer.
Printing Network Settings

Check5 Have you entered the proper password specified for the Wireless Direct?
To check the password specified for the printer, print out the network setting information of the printer.
Printing Network Settings

Check6 Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the device.
If the distance between the printer and device is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place the
printer and device close to each other.

Check7 Make sure 5 devices are already connected.


Wireless Direct does not allow more than 5 devices to be connected.

Cannot Print/Scan/Fax through Network

Check1 Make sure the computer is connected to the wireless router.


For more on how to check the computer settings or connection status, see your computer instruction manual
or contact its manufacturer.

Check2 If MP Drivers are not installed, install them. (Windows)


Install the MP Drivers using the Setup CD-ROM or install them from the Canon website.

Check3 Make sure wireless router does not restrict which computers can access it.

347
For more on connecting to and setting up your wireless router, see the wireless router instruction manual or
contact its manufacturer.

Note
• To check the MAC address or IP address of your computer, see Checking Computer IP Address or MAC
Address.

348
Network Key (Password) Unknown

WPA/WPA2 or WEP Key Set for Wireless Router Unknown, Cannot Connect
Setting an Encryption Key

WPA/WPA2 or WEP Key Set for Wireless Router Unknown, Cannot


Connect

For more on setting up a wireless router, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or
contact its manufacturer. Make sure your computer can communicate with the wireless router.

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.


• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility


• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Setting an Encryption Key

For more on setting up a wireless router, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or
contact its manufacturer. Make sure your computer can communicate with the wireless router.

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

349
Selecting WPA, WPA2, or WPA/WPA2 is recommended for security reason. If your wireless router is
compatible with WPA/WPA2, you can also use WPA2 or WPA.

• Using WPA/WPA2 (Windows)


The authentication method, Wi-Fi password, and dynamic encryption type must be identical among
the wireless router, the printer, and your computer.

Enter the Wi-Fi password configured on the wireless router.

Either TKIP (basic encryption) or AES (secure encryption) is selected automatically as the dynamic
encryption method.

For details, see If WPA/WPA2 Details Screen Appears.

Note
• This printer supports WPA/WPA2-PSK (WPA/WPA2-Personal) and WPA2-PSK (WPA2-
Personal).

• Using WEP

The length or format of the Wi-Fi password and authentication method must be identical among the
wireless router, the printer, and your computer.

To communicate with a wireless router that generates a password automatically, you must set the
printer to use the password generated by the wireless router.

◦ For Windows:

When the WEP Details screen appears after you click Search... on the Network Settings (Wi-Fi)
screen in IJ Network Device Setup Utility, follow the on-screen instructions to set the password
length, format, and the password to use.

For details, see If WEP Details Screen Appears.

Note
• If the printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via LAN:

If the printer is connected to an AirPort Base Station via a LAN, check the settings in Wireless
Security of AirPort Utility.
• Select 64 bit if WEP 40 bit is selected for password length in AirPort Base Station.
• Select 1 for the password to use. Otherwise, computer will not be able to communicate with
printer via the wireless router.

350
Printer Cannot Be Used After Replacing Wireless Router or
Changed Router Settings

When you replace a wireless router, redo the network setup for the printer according to the replaced one.

• For Windows:
Perform setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

• For macOS:

Perform setup from the web page.

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility

See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

If this does not solve the problem, see below.


Cannot Communicate with Printer After Enabling MAC/IP Address Filtering or Encryption Key on
Wireless Router
With Encryption On, Cannot Communicate with Printer After Changing Encryption Type at Wireless
Router

Cannot Communicate with Printer After Enabling MAC/IP Address


Filtering or Encryption Key on Wireless Router

Check1 Check wireless router setting.


To check the wireless router setting, see the instruction manual provided with the wireless router or contact its
manufacturer. Make sure the computer and the wireless router can communicate with each other under this
setting.

351
Check2 If filtering MAC addresses or IP addresses at wireless router, check that MAC
addresses or IP addresses for computer, network device, and printer are registered.

Check3 If using WPA/WPA2 key or a password, make sure encryption key for
computer, network device, and printer matches key set for wireless router.
The length or format of the Wi-Fi password and authentication method must be identical among the wireless
router, the printer, and your computer.

For details, see Setting an Encryption Key.

With Encryption On, Cannot Communicate with Printer After


Changing Encryption Type at Wireless Router

If you change the encryption type for the printer and it subsequently cannot communicate with the
computer, make sure the encryption type for the computer and the wireless router matches the type set
for the printer.

Cannot Communicate with Printer After Enabling MAC/IP Address Filtering or Encryption Key on
Wireless Router

352
Other Network Problems

Checking Network Information

Restoring to Factory Defaults

353
Checking Network Information

Checking Printer IP Address or MAC Address


Checking Computer IP Address or MAC Address
Checking Communication Between the Computer, the Printer, and the Wireless Router
Checking Network Setting Information

Checking Printer IP Address or MAC Address

To check the printer's IP Address or MAC address, print out the network settings information.

Printing Network Settings

For Windows, you can check the network setting information on the computer screen.
Canon IJ Network Device Setup Utility Screen

Checking Computer IP Address or MAC Address

To check the IP Address or MAC address of your computer, follow the instructions below.

• For Windows:

1. Select Command Prompt as shown below.


In Windows 10, right-click Start and select Command Prompt.

In Windows 8.1, select Command Prompt from the Start screen. If Command Prompt is not
displayed on the Start screen, select the Search charm and search for "Command Prompt".

In Windows 7, click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.

2. Enter "ipconfig/all" and press Enter.


The IP address and MAC address of your computer appear. If your computer is not connected to a
network, the IP address does not appear.

• For macOS:

1. Select System Preferences from Apple menu, and then click Network.

2. Make sure network interface used by computer is selected, and then click Advanced.
Make sure Wi-Fi is selected as network interface.

3. Click TCP/IP to check the IP address, or click Hardware to check the MAC address.

354
Checking Communication Between the Computer, the Printer, and the
Wireless Router

Perform a ping test to check if communication is taking place.

• For Windows:

1. Select Command Prompt as shown below.


In Windows 10, right-click Start and select Command Prompt.
In Windows 8.1, select Command Prompt from the Start screen. If Command Prompt is not
displayed on the Start screen, select the Search charm and search for "Command Prompt".
In Windows 7, click Start > All Programs > Accessories > Command Prompt.

2. Type the ping command and press Enter.


The ping command is as follows: ping XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX

"XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX" is the IP address of the target device.

If communication is taking place, a message like the one shown below appears.

Reply from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: bytes=32 time=10ms TTL=255

If Request timed out appears, communication is not taking place.

• For macOS:

1. Start Network Utility as shown below.


Select Computer from Go menu of Finder, double-click Macintosh HD > System > Library >
CoreServices > Applications > Network Utility.

2. Click Ping.

3. Make sure Send only XX pings (XX are numbers) is selected.

4. Enter IP address of target printer or target wireless router in Enter the network
address to ping.

5. Click Ping.
"XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX" is the IP address of the target device.

A message such as the following appears.

64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=0 ttl=64 time=3.394 ms

64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=1 ttl=64 time=1.786 ms

64 bytes from XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX: icmp_seq=2 ttl=64 time=1.739 ms

355
--- XXX.XXX.XXX.XXX ping statistics ---
3 packets transmitted, 3 packets received, 0% packet loss

If packet loss is 100%, communication is not taking place. Otherwise, computer is communicating
with target device.

Checking Network Setting Information

To check the printer's network settings information, print out the network settings information.

Printing Network Settings

356
Restoring to Factory Defaults

Important
• For Windows:
Initialization erases all network settings on the printer, making printing, scanning, or faxing operation
from a computer over a network impossible. To use the printer over a network again after restoring it to
the factory defaults, redo setup using the Setup CD-ROM or from the web page.

• For macOS:

Initialization erases all network settings on the printer, making printing, scanning, or faxing operation
from a computer over a network impossible. To use the printer over a network again after restoring it to
the factory defaults, redo setup from the web page.

Initialize the network setting using the printer's operation panel.

Reset setting

357
Problems while Printing/Scanning from Smartphone/Tablet

Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet

358
Cannot Print/Scan from Smartphone/Tablet

If you cannot print/scan from your smartphone/tablet, it is possible that your smartphone/tablet cannot
communicate with the printer.

Check the cause of your problem according to the connection method.


Cannot Communicate with Printer over Wireless LAN
Cannot Communicate with Printer while It Is in Wireless Direct

Note
• For problems on printing with other connection methods or more on performing settings of each
connection method:

Using PIXMA/MAXIFY Cloud Link


Printing with Google Cloud Print
Printing from iOS Device (AirPrint)

Cannot Communicate with Printer over Wireless LAN

If your smartphone/tablet cannot communicate with the printer, check the following.

Check1 Check the power status of printer, network devices (e.g. wireless router), and
smartphone/tablet.
• Turn on the printer or devices.
• If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.
• It may be necessary to resolve wireless router problems (e.g. update interval of a key, problems of DHCP
update interval, energy saving mode, etc.) or to update the wireless router firmware.

For details, contact the manufacturer of your wireless router.

Check2 Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).


Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.

For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.

Check3 Is the printer connected to the wireless router?

Use the icon on the LCD to check the connection status between the printer and wireless router. If the
icon is not displayed, Wi-Fi is disabled. Turn on wireless communication on the printer.

Check4 Are network settings of printer identical with those of wireless router?
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are
identical with those of the wireless router.

To check the settings of the wireless router, refer to the instruction manual provided with it or contact its
manufacturer.

359
To check the current network settings of the printer, print out the network setting information.

Printing Network Settings

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility


See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.
• For Windows:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:

Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Check5 Are network settings of your smartphone/tablet identical with those of wireless
router?
Make sure the network settings of the printer (e.g. network name (SSID) or network key (password), etc.) are
identical with those of the wireless router.
To check the settings of your smartphone/tablet, refer to the instruction manual provided with it.
If the network settings of your smartphone/tablet are not identical with those of the wireless router, change the
network settings of it to match with those of the wireless router.

Check6 Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the wireless router.
If the distance between the printer and wireless router is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place
the printer and wireless router close to each other.

Note
• Though an antenna is attached to most wireless routers, note that some of them have it inside.

Check7 Make sure wireless signal is strong. Monitor signal status and move printer
and wireless router as necessary.
Place the printer and wireless router where there are no obstacles between them. Wireless communication
between different rooms or floors is generally poor. Wireless communication can be impeded by building
materials containing metal or concrete. If the printer cannot communicate with the computer over a Wi-Fi due
to a wall, place the printer and the computer in the same room.

In addition, if a device like a microwave oven that emits radio waves of the same frequency bandwidth as a
wireless router is nearby, it may cause interference. Place the wireless router as far away from interference
sources as possible.

Check the signal strength on the LCD.

LCD and Operation Panel

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status.

360
Select the link below to download IJ Network Device Setup Utility and install it.

Checking Printer Connection Status Using IJ Network Device Setup Utility


See below for starting up IJ Network Device Setup Utility.

• For Windows:
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

• For macOS:
Starting Up IJ Network Device Setup Utility

Cannot Communicate with Printer while It Is in Wireless Direct

If your smartphone/tablet cannot communicate with the printer in the Wireless Direct, check the following.

Check1 Check the power status of printer and other devices (smartphone or tablet).
Turn on the printer or devices.
If the power is already turned on, cycle the power switch.

Check2 Is Wireless Direct enabled?


From the Setup menu screen, select Device settings > LAN settings > Wireless Direct > Switch WL
Direct in this order and select Yes.

Check3 Check the settings of your device (smartphone/tablet).


Make sure Wi-Fi is enabled on your device.
For details, refer to your device's instruction manual.

Check4 Make sure printer is selected as connection for device (e.g. smartphone or
tablet).
Select the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer as the connection destination for
devices.

Check the destination on your device.

For details, refer to your device's instruction manual or visit the manufacturer's website.

To check the network name (SSID) for Wireless Direct specified for the printer, print out the network setting
information of the printer.

Printing Network Settings

Check5 Have you entered the proper password specified for the Wireless Direct?
To check the password specified for the printer, print out the network setting information of the printer.

Printing Network Settings

361
Check6 Make sure the printer is not placed too far away from the device.
If the distance between the printer and device is too far, wireless communication becomes poor. Place the
printer and device close to each other.

Check7 Make sure 5 devices are already connected.


Wireless Direct does not allow more than 5 devices to be connected.

362
Printing Problems

Printer Does Not Print

Ink Does Not Come Out

Paper Does Not Feed Properly/"No Paper" Error

Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

363
Printer Does Not Print

Check1 Make sure printer is turned on.


If not, make sure the printer is securely plugged in and press ON button to turn on.

The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.

Note
• If you are printing large data such as photos or other graphics, printing may take longer to start. The ON
lamp flashes while the computer is processing data and sending it to the printer. Wait until printing starts.

Check2 Make sure printer is properly connected to computer.


If you are using a USB cable, make sure it is securely connected to both the printer and the computer. When the
USB cable is securely plugged in, check the following:

• If you are using a relay device such as a USB hub, disconnect it, connect the printer directly to the
computer, and retry the printing. If printing starts normally, there is a problem with the relay device. Contact
the vendor of the relay device.

• There could also be a problem with the USB cable. Replace the USB cable and retry the printing.

If you use the printer over a LAN, make sure the printer is correctly set up for network use.
Cannot Find Printer while Using Wi-Fi

Note
• IJ Network Device Setup Utility allows you to diagnose and repair the network status. Download it from the
web page.
For Windows
For macOS

Check3 Make sure paper settings match information set for cassette.
If the paper settings do not match the information set for the cassette, an error message appears on the LCD.
Follow the instructions on the LCD to solve the problem.

Note
• You can select whether the message which prevents misprinting is displayed.

• To change the message view setting when printing or copying using the printer's operation panel:

Feed settings

• To change the message view setting when printing using the printer driver:
Changing the Printer Operation Mode (Windows)

364
Changing the Printer Operation Mode (macOS)

Check4 If printing from a computer, delete jobs stuck in print queue.


• For Windows:
Deleting the Undesired Print Job

• For macOS:

Deleting the Undesired Print Job

Check5 Is your printer's printer driver selected when printing?


The printer will not print properly if you are using a printer driver for a different printer.
• For Windows:

Make sure "Canon XXX series" (where "XXX" is your printer's name) is selected in the Print dialog box.

Note
• If multiple printers are registered to your computer, select Set as Default Printer for a printer to make
the one selected by default.

• For macOS:
Make sure your printer's name is selected in Printer in the Print dialog.

Note
• If multiple printers are registered to your computer, select Set as Default Printer from System
Preferences > Printers & Scanners for a printer to make the one selected by default.

Check6 Are you trying to print a large data file? (Windows)


If you are trying to print a large file, it takes a long time to start printing.
If the printer does not start printing after a certain period of time, select On for Prevention of Print Data Loss.
For details, refer to Page Setup Tab Description.

Important
• Selecting On for Prevention of Print Data Loss may reduce print quality.
• After printing is completed, select Off for Prevention of Print Data Loss.

Check7 If printing from a computer, restart the computer.


Restart the computer and try printing again.

365
Ink Does Not Come Out

Check1 Make sure of the estimated ink levels in the FINE cartridges.
Replace empty FINE cartridges with new ones.

Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Check2 Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?


If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.
Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.

Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.

After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.

Check3 Are the print head nozzles clogged?


Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.

For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing
Is Faint or Uneven.

• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:

After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.

• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:

Perform print head deep cleaning.

366
If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power
supply.

• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:
Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.

367
Paper Does Not Feed Properly/"No Paper" Error

Check1 Make sure paper is loaded.


Loading Paper

Check2 When loading paper, consider the following.


• When loading two or more sheets of paper, flip through the paper before loading it.

• When loading two or more sheets of paper, align the edges of the sheets before loading the paper.
• When loading two or more sheets of paper, make sure the paper stack does not exceed the paper load
limit.
However, paper may not feed correctly at the maximum capacity, depending on the type of paper or
environmental conditions (very high or low temperature and humidity). In such cases, reduce the amount of
paper you load at a time to less than half of the paper load limit.

• Always load the paper in portrait orientation, regardless of the printing orientation.
• When you load the paper, load the paper with the print side facing DOWN and slide the paper guides to
align with the both sides of the paper.
Loading Paper

• When you load the paper, insert the paper stack until the leading edge touches the far end of the cassette.

Check3 Is paper too thick or curled?


Unsupported Media Types

Check4 When loading envelopes, consider the following.


When printing on envelopes, see Loading Envelopes, and prepare the envelopes before printing.

Once you have prepared the envelopes, load them in portrait orientation. If the envelopes are placed in
landscape orientation, they will not feed properly.

Check5 Is the cassette set properly?

Push the cassette so that the mark on the cassette aligns with the front panel as illustrated below.

368
Check6 Make sure media type and paper size settings match with loaded paper.

Check7 If multiple sheets of plain paper is fed from the printer, select the setting for
preventing double-feed of plain paper.
If multiple sheets of plain paper is fed from the printer, select the setting for preventing double-feed of plain paper
using the operation panel or your computer.
* After printing is finished, disable the setting for preventing double-feed of plain paper; otherwise, the setting is
applied from the next time.

• To set by using the operation panel


Press the Setup button, select Device settings and Print settings in this order, and then set Prevent
double-feed to ON.
Changing Settings from Operation Panel

• To set by using your computer (Windows)

1. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.


Maintenance Tab Description

2. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select
OK.

3. Select Custom Settings.

4. Select the Prevent paper double-feed check box.

5. Select OK on the displayed screen.

6. Select OK.

7. Select OK on the displayed screen.

Check8 Clean paper feed roller.


Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers

369
If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a
repair.

370
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

If the print results are unsatisfactory due to white streaks, misaligned/distorted lines, or uneven colors, check
the paper and print quality settings first.

Check1 Do page size and media type settings match size and type of loaded paper?
If these settings do not match, it is not possible to obtain the proper result.
If you are printing a photograph or an illustration, an incorrect paper type setting may reduce the quality of the
printout color.
Also, if you print with an incorrect paper type setting, the printed surface may be scratched.

In borderless printing, uneven coloring may occur depending on the combination of the paper type setting and
the loaded paper.
The method for checking the paper and print quality settings differs depending on what you are using your printer
for.

• Copying
Check the settings using the operation panel.
Setting Items for Copying

• Printing from your computer


Check the settings using the printer driver.
Basic Printing Setup

• Printing from your smartphone/tablet using Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY


Check the settings on Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY.
Print Easily from a Smartphone or Tablet with Canon PRINT Inkjet/SELPHY

Check2 Make sure appropriate print quality is selected (see list above).
Select a print quality suited to the paper and to what you are printing. If you notice blurs or uneven colors,
increase the print quality setting and retry the printing.

Check3 If problem is not resolved, check also the sections below.


See also the sections below:

Printouts Are Blank/Blurry or Fuzzy/Inaccurate or Bleeding Colors/Streaks or Lines


Colors Are Unclear
Lines Are Misaligned/Distorted
Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is Scratched
Vertical Line Next to Image
Cannot Complete Printing
Part of Page Is Not Printed (Windows)

371
Lines Incomplete or Missing (Windows)
Images Incomplete or Missing (Windows)
Ink Blots / Paper Curl
Back of Paper Is Smudged
Uneven or Streaked Colors

If Printed Paper Has Been Discolored


Colors may fade with time if the printed paper is left for a long period of time.

After printing, dry the paper sufficiently, avoid high temperatures, high humidity, and direct sunlight, and
store or display indoors at room temperature and normal humidity.

To avoid direct exposure to air, we recommend that you store the paper in an album, plastic folder, photo
frame, etc.

372
Printouts Are Blank/Blurry or Fuzzy/Inaccurate or Bleeding Colors/
Streaks or Lines

Printing Is Blurry

Colors Are Wrong

373
White Streaks Appear

Check1 Check paper and print quality settings.


Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

Check2 Make sure of the estimated ink levels in the FINE cartridges.
Replace empty FINE cartridges with new ones.
Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Check3 Are the print head nozzles clogged?


Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.
For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing
Is Faint or Uneven.

• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:


After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.

• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:


Perform print head deep cleaning.
If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power
supply.

• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:

Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.

Check4 When using paper with one printable surface, make sure paper is loaded with
printable side facing down.
Printing on the wrong side of such paper may cause unclear prints or prints with reduced quality.

Load paper with the printable side facing up.

Refer to the instruction manual supplied with the paper for detailed information on the printable side.

374
Check5 Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?
If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.

Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.

Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.

After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.

• When copying, see also the sections below:

Check6 Is platen glass or glass of ADF dirty?


Clean the platen glass or the glass of ADF.
Cleaning Platen and Document Cover

Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

Note
• If the glass of ADF is dirty, black streaks appear on the paper as shown below.

Check7 Make sure original is properly loaded on platen or ADF.


When you load the original on the platen, load it with the side to be copied facing down.

When you load the original on the ADF, load it with the side to be copied facing up.

Loading Originals

375
Check8 Is copy source a printed paper by printer?
If you use a printout done by this printer as the original, print quality may be reduced depending on the condition
of the original.

Print from the printer directly, or reprint from the computer if you can reprint from it.

376
Colors Are Unclear

Check1 Are the print head nozzles clogged?


Print the nozzle check pattern to determine whether the ink ejects properly from the print head nozzles.

For details on printing the nozzle check pattern, print head cleaning, and print head deep cleaning, see If Printing
Is Faint or Uneven.
• If nozzle check pattern is not printed correctly:

After performing the print head cleaning, print the nozzle check pattern and examine the pattern.
• If problem is not resolved after performing print head cleaning twice:

Perform print head deep cleaning.


If the problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning, turn off the printer and perform
print head deep cleaning again 24 hours later. When you turn the printer off, do not unplug it from the power
supply.

• If problem is not resolved after performing print head deep cleaning twice:
Ink may have run out. Replace the FINE cartridge.

Check2 When a FINE cartridge runs out of ink, replace it with a new one.
Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Check3 Is the FINE cartridge installed properly?


If the FINE cartridge is not installed securely, ink may not be ejected correctly.
Open the paper output cover and remove the FINE cartridges.
Then install the FINE cartridges again. Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.

377
After confirming that the FINE cartridge is installed properly, close the paper output cover.

Note
• Printed colors may not match screen colors due to basic differences in the methods used to produce
colors. Color control settings and environmental differences can also affect how colors appear on the
screen. Therefore, colors of printing results may be different from those on the screen.

378
Lines Are Misaligned/Distorted

Check1 Perform print head alignment.


If printed lines are misaligned/distorted or print results are otherwise unsatisfactory, adjust the print head
position.
Aligning the Print Head

Note
• If the problem is not resolved after performing the print head alignment, perform print head alignment
manually from your computer.

• For Windows:
Adjusting Print Head Position Manually

• For macOS:
Adjusting Print Head Position

Check2 Check paper and print quality settings.


Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

Check3 Increase print quality and try printing again.


Increasing the print quality may improve the print result.

379
Paper Is Smudged / Printed Surface Is Scratched
Paper Is Smudged

Smudged Edges Smudged Surface

Printed Surface Is Scratched

Check1 Check paper and print quality settings.


Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

Check2 Check paper type.


Make sure you are using the right paper for what you are printing.
Supported Media Types

Check3 Correct curl before loading paper.


When using Photo Paper Plus Semi-gloss, even if the sheet is curled, load one sheet at a time as it is. Rolling
this paper in the opposite direction to flatten it may crack the paper surface and reduce the print quality.

We recommend putting unused paper back into the package and storing it flat.

• Plain Paper

Turn the paper over and reload it to print on the other side.

• Other Paper such as envelope

If the paper corners curl more than 0.1 inch / 3 mm (A) in height, the paper may smudge or may not feed
properly. Follow the instructions below to correct the paper curl.

380
1. Roll up paper in opposite direction to paper curl as shown below.

2. Check that paper is now flat.


We recommend printing curl-corrected paper one sheet at a time.

Note
• Depending on paper type, the paper may smudge or may not feed properly even if it is not curled inward.
Follow the instructions below to curl the paper outward up to 0.1 inch / 3 mm (B) in height before printing.
This may improve the print result.

(C) Print side


We recommend feeding paper that has been curled outward one sheet at a time.

Check4 Set printer to prevent paper abrasion.


Adjusting the setting to prevent paper abrasion will widen the clearance between the print head and the paper. If
you notice abrasion even with the media type set correctly to match the paper, set the printer to prevent paper
abrasion using the operation panel or the computer.

This may reduce the print speed.

* Once you have finished printing, undo this setting. Otherwise, it will apply to subsequent print jobs.

• From operation panel

Press the Setup button and select Device settings > Print settings in this order, and then set Prevent
abrasion to ON.

Changing Settings from Operation Panel

• From computer

◦ For Windows:

1. Make sure printer is turned on.

381
2. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.
Maintenance Tab Description

3. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select
OK.

4. Select Custom Settings.

5. Select Prevent paper abrasion check box and click OK.


◦ For macOS:
Adjust the setting to prevent paper abrasion from Remote UI.

Opening Remote UI for Maintenance

Check5 If intensity is set high, reduce intensity setting and try printing again.
If you are printing with a high intensity setting on plain paper, the paper may absorb too much ink and become
wavy, causing paper abrasion.

• Printing from your computer (Windows)


Check the intensity setting in the printer driver.
Adjusting Intensity

• Copying
Setting Items for Copying

Check6 Is platen glass or glass of ADF dirty?


Clean the platen glass or the glass of ADF.
Cleaning Platen and Document Cover

Cleaning the ADF (Auto Document Feeder)

Note
• If the glass of ADF is dirty, black streaks appear on the paper as shown below.

Check7 Is paper feed roller dirty?


Clean paper feed roller.

Cleaning Paper Feed Rollers

Check8 Is inside of printer dirty?

382
During duplex printing, ink may stain the inside of the printer, smudging the printout.

Perform bottom plate cleaning to clean inside of printer.

Cleaning Inside the Printer (Bottom Plate Cleaning)

Note
• To prevent staining inside the printer, be sure to set the correct paper size.

Check9 Set longer ink drying time.


This allows the printed surface to dry, preventing smudges and scratches.
• For Windows:

1. Make sure printer is turned on.

2. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.


Maintenance Tab Description

3. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select
OK.

4. Select Custom Settings.

5. Drag Ink Drying Wait Time slide bar to set the wait time and click OK.

6. Check message and click OK.


• For macOS:
Set the waiting time using Remote UI.
Changing the Printer Operation Mode

383
Vertical Line Next to Image

Check Is loaded paper size correct?


If the loaded paper is larger than the size you specified, a vertical line may appear in the margin.
Set the paper size to match the loaded paper.
Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

Note
• The direction of the vertical line pattern may vary depending on the image data or the print setting.
• This printer performs automatic cleaning when necessary to keep printouts clean. A small amount of ink is
ejected for cleaning.
Although the ink is normally ejected onto the ink absorber at the outer edge of the paper, it may get onto
the paper if the loaded paper is larger than the set size.

384
Scanning Problems (macOS)

Scanning Problems

385
Scanning Problems

Scanner Does Not Work

Scanner Driver Does Not Start

386
Scanner Does Not Work

Check 1 Check that your scanner or printer is turned on.

Check 2 With network connection, check the connection status and reconnect as
needed.

Check 3 With USB connection, connect the USB cable to a different USB port on the
computer.

Check 4 If the USB cable is connected to a USB hub, remove it from the USB hub and
connect it to a USB port on the computer.

Check 5 Restart the computer.

Check 6 To scan from the printer's operation panel with USB connection, click Scan-
from-Operation-Panel Settings in the Settings (General Settings) dialog, and then
check that the following checkboxes are selected.
• Your scanner or printer
• Enables scanning from the operation panel

387
Scanner Driver Does Not Start

Check 1 Make sure the application software supports AirPrint.

Check 2 Select your scanner or printer on the application's menu.


Note
• The operation may differ depending on the application.

Check 3 Scan and save images with IJ Scan Utility Lite and open the files in your
application.

388
Faxing Problems

Problems Sending Faxes

Problems Receiving Faxes

Telephone Problems

Poor Quality Fax Received

389
Problems Sending Faxes

Cannot Send a Fax

Errors Often Occur When Send a Fax

390
Cannot Send a Fax

Check1 Is power turned on?


• You cannot send faxes if the power is turned off. Press the ON button to turn the power on.
• If you unplugged the power cord without turning off the power (the ON lamp is lit), reconnecting it turns on
the power automatically.
• If you unplugged the power cord after pressing the ON button to turn off the power (the ON lamp is off),
reconnect it, and then press the ON button to turn on the power.
• If the power was turned off due to power failure, etc., the power is automatically turned on when the power
failure is resolved.

Important
• Confirm that the ON lamp is off before unplugging the power cord, and then unplug the power cord.
If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.
For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.

Note
• If the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted by a power failure or unplugging the power cord, the
list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed after turning
the printer on.
Summary of Reports and Lists

Check2 Is document being sent from memory or the fax being received into memory?
When the message for the transmission/reception is displayed on the Fax standby screen, a fax is being sent
from/received into printer's memory. Wait until the transmission/reception is complete.

Check3 Is printer's memory full?


Delete contents in memory, and then send a fax again.

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

Check4 Is telephone line type set correctly?


Check the telephone line type setting and change it as necessary.

Setting Telephone Line Type

Check5 Is Hook setting set to Disable?


When you send a fax manually, dial the number with Enable selected for Hook setting in Security control
under Fax settings, or dial the number using the telephone connected to the printer.

391
Fax settings

Check6 Is Dial tone detect set to ON?


Resend the fax after a while.
If you still cannot send the fax, select OFF for Dial tone detect in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.

Fax settings

Check7 Is fax number registered correctly in printer's directory?


Check the recipient's fax/telephone number, correct the fax/telephone number registered in the printer's
directory, and then send the document again.

Changing Registered Information

Note
• You can check the registered information in the printer's directory by printing RECIPIENT TELEPHONE
NUMBER LIST.

Summary of Reports and Lists

Check8 Does an error occur during transmission?


• Ensure that a message is displayed on the Fax standby screen. When a message is displayed on the Fax
standby screen, check the cause.
A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD

• Print ACTIVITY REPORT and check for an error.


Summary of Reports and Lists

If a transmission error has occurred, see below.


Errors Often Occur When Send a Fax

Check9 Is document loaded properly?


Remove the document, and then reload it on the platen or in the ADF.
Loading Originals

Check10 Does a printer error occur?


Ensure that an error message is displayed on the LCD. When an error message is displayed on the LCD, check
the cause.

When the error message and support code are displayed, refer to List of Support Code for Error.

When only the error message is displayed, refer to Message (Support Code) Appears.

If you are in a hurry, press the Stop button to close the message, and then send the fax.

Check11 Is telephone line connected correctly?


Reconnect the telephone line cable to the telephone line jack.

Connecting Telephone Line

392
If the telephone line is connected correctly, there is a problem with your telephone line. Contact your telephone
company and the manufacturer of your terminal adapter or telephone adapter.

393
Errors Often Occur When Send a Fax

Check Check telephone line condition or connection.


If errors occur frequently when using an Internet telephone, it is possible that they can be reduced by selecting
Reduce for Err reduction (VoIP) on Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.

For details, see Err reduction (VoIP).

Fax settings

Note
• If selecting Reduce does not reduce errors, select Do not reduce.

In addition, when using an Internet telephone, it is possible that errors occur more often if 4800 bps or 9600 bps
is selected for TX start speed. Select 14400 bps or 33600 bps.
If the telephone line or connection is poor when using a general telephone, reducing the transmission start speed
may correct the error.
Reduce the transmission start speed on TX start speed in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under
Fax settings.

Fax settings

394
Problems Receiving Faxes

Cannot Receive a Fax, Cannot Print a Fax

395
Cannot Receive a Fax, Cannot Print a Fax

Check1 Is power turned on?


• You cannot receive faxes if the power is turned off. Press the ON button to turn the power on.
• If you unplugged the power cord without turning off the power (the ON lamp is lit), reconnecting it turns on
the power automatically.
• If you unplugged the power cord after pressing the ON button to turn off the power (the ON lamp is off),
reconnect it, and then press the ON button to turn on the power.
• If the power was turned off due to power failure, etc., the power is automatically turned on when the power
failure is resolved.

Important
• Confirm that the ON lamp is off before unplugging the power cord, and then unplug the power cord.
If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.
For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.

Note
• If the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted by a power failure or unplugging the power cord, the
list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY CLEAR REPORT) will be printed after turning
the printer on.
Summary of Reports and Lists

Check2 Is the printer's memory full?


Print the received faxes stored in the printer's memory or save them on the memory card, and then delete them
from the printer's memory and have the sender resend the faxes.
Document Stored in Printer's Memory

Check3 Does an error occur during reception?


• Ensure that a message is displayed on the Fax standby screen. When a message is displayed on the Fax
standby screen, check the cause.

A Message for Faxing Is Displayed on the LCD

• Print ACTIVITY REPORT and check for an error.

Summary of Reports and Lists

If a reception error has occurred, see below.

Errors Often Occur When Received a Fax

Check4 Is telephone line cable connected to external device jack?

396
Reconnect it to the telephone line jack.

Connecting Telephone Line

Check5 Is paper loaded?


If paper is not loaded, received faxes will be stored in the printer's memory without being printed (Memory
Reception). Load paper, and then press the OK button.

Check6 Is a different size of paper from that specified by Page size in FAX paper
settings loaded?
If a different size of paper from that specified by Page size is loaded for printing faxes, the received faxes will not
be printed and will be stored in the printer's memory (Memory Reception). Load the same size of paper as that
specified by Page size, then press the OK button.

Check7 Is amount of remaining ink sufficient to print a fax?


If the amount of remaining ink is insufficient to print, received faxes will be stored in the printer's memory without
being printed (Memory Reception). Replace the FINE cartridge, and then print the faxes in the printer's memory.

Document Stored in Printer's Memory

Note
• If the printer was receiving faxes in the fax mode, printing will start automatically after the FINE cartridge is
replaced.
Replacing a FINE Cartridge

• When the printer receives black & white faxes in the printer's memory, if ON is selected for 2-sided in FAX
paper settings, selecting OFF may print the faxes.

• You can set the printer to forcibly print a received fax even if the ink has run out.
Set Print when no ink in Auto print settings under Fax settings to Print.
However, part or all of the fax may not be printed since the ink has run out.
Also, the contents of the fax will not be stored in the printer's memory.
If the ink has already run out, we recommend that Do not print be selected for Received documents in
Auto print settings under Fax settings to store the received fax in the printer's memory. After you replace
the FINE cartridge and select Print for Received documents in Auto print settings, the fax stored in the
printer's memory will be printed automatically.

Fax settings

Check8 Is printer set to appropriate receive mode?


Check the receive mode setting and change it to a mode suited to your connection if necessary.

Setting Receive Mode

Check9 Is FAX RX reject set to ON?


Select OFF for FAX RX reject in Security control under Fax settings.

For details, refer to Rejecting Fax Reception.

397
Check10 Are there setting items set Reject in Caller rejection?
If you select Reject for any setting items in Caller rejection in Security control under Fax settings, the printer
rejects calls for setting item selected Reject.

For details, refer to Using Caller ID Service to Reject Calls.

398
Telephone Problems

Cannot Dial

Telephone Disconnects During a Call

399
Cannot Dial

Check1 Is telephone line cable connected correctly?


Check that the telephone line cable is connected correctly.

Connecting Telephone Line

Check2 Is telephone line type of printer or external device set correctly?


Check the telephone line type setting and change it as necessary.
Setting Telephone Line Type

400
Telephone Disconnects During a Call

Check Is telephone line cable or telephone (or a peripheral device such as an external
telephone, an answering device, or a computer modem) connected correctly?
Check that the telephone line cable and the telephone (or a peripheral device such as an external telephone, an
answering device, or a computer modem) are connected correctly.
Connecting Telephone Line

401
Poor Quality Fax Received

Check1 Check scan settings of sender's fax device.


Ask the sender to adjust the scan settings of the fax device.

Check2 Is ECM RX set to OFF?


Select ON for ECM RX in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.
If ECM RX is enabled, the sender's fax device resends the fax after correcting errors automatically.

Fax settings

Check3 Is sender's original document or scanning area of sender's fax device dirty?
The image quality of the fax is mainly determined by the sender's fax device. Contact the sender and ask the
sender to check whether the scanning area of the fax device is dirty.

Check4 Is ECM transmission/reception enabled although the line/connection is poor, or


is the sender's fax device compatible with ECM?
• Select ON for ECM RX in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under Fax settings.
Fax settings

• Contact the sender and ask the sender to check whether the fax device is set to enable ECM transmission.
If the sender's or recipient's fax device is not compatible with ECM, the fax will be sent/received without
automatic error correction.

• Reduce the reception start speed on RX start speed in Adv. communication in Adv. FAX settings under
Fax settings.
Fax settings

Check5 Did you confirm paper and print quality settings?


Printout Results Are Unsatisfactory

402
Mechanical Problems

Printer Does Not Turn On

Printer Turns Off Unexpectedly or Repeatedly

USB Connection Problems

Cannot Communicate with Printer via USB

Wrong Language Appears in LCD

403
Printer Does Not Turn On

Check1 Press ON button.

Check2 Make sure power plug is securely connected to printer, and then turn on again.

Check3 Unplug printer, leave it for at least 2 minutes, and then plug it back in and turn
on again.
If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

404
Printer Turns Off Unexpectedly or Repeatedly

Check If printer is set to turn off automatically after a certain time, disable this setting.
If you have set the printer to turn off automatically after a specified time, the power will shut off by itself once that
time has elapsed.
• To disable the setting from the operation panel:

1. Check that printer is turned on.

2. Press the Setup button, use the button to select ECO settings, and press the OK
button.
LCD and Operation Panel

3. Use the button to select EnergySaveSettings and then press the OK button.

4. Use the button to select Auto power off and then press the OK button.

5. Use the button to select OFF and then press the OK button.
The setting to shut off the power automatically is disabled.

• To disable the setting from the computer:


For Windows, use Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool or ScanGear (scanner driver) to disable the setting.
Follow the procedure below to disable the setting using Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.

1. Open Canon IJ Printer Assistant Tool.


Maintenance Tab Description

2. Select Select Printer... and select printer you are using from pulldown menu and select
OK.

3. Select Auto Power.

4. Select Disable for Auto Power Off.

5. Select OK.

6. Select OK on the displayed screen.

405
The setting to shut off the power automatically is disabled.

Note
• Refer to below to disable the setting from ScanGear (scanner driver).

Scanner Tab

406
USB Connection Problems

Printing or Scanning Is Slow/Hi-Speed USB Connection Does Not


Work/"This device can perform faster" Message Appears (Windows)

If your system environment does not support Hi-Speed USB, the printer operates at the slower speed of
USB 1.1. In this case, the printer works properly but printing or scanning speed may slow down due to the
communication speed.

Check Check following to make sure your system environment supports Hi-Speed
USB connection.
• Does the USB port on your computer support Hi-Speed USB connection?

• Does the USB cable or the USB hub support Hi-Speed USB connection?

Be sure to use a certified Hi-Speed USB cable. We recommend that the USB cable be no longer than 10
feet / 3 meters or so.

• Is the Hi-Speed USB driver working properly on your computer?


Make sure the latest Hi-Speed USB driver is working properly and obtain and install the latest version of
the Hi-Speed USB driver for your computer, if necessary.

Important
• For more information, contact the manufacturer of your computer, USB cable, or USB hub.

407
Cannot Communicate with Printer via USB

Check1 Make sure printer is turned on.

Check2 Connect USB cable properly.


As the illustration below, the USB port is at the back of the printer.

Important
• Connect the "Type-B" terminal to the printer with the notched side facing UP. For details, refer to the
instruction manual supplied with the USB cable.

Check3 Make sure Enable bidirectional support is selected in the Ports sheet of the
properties dialog box of the printer driver. (Windows)
If not, select it to enable bidirectional support.
Opening Printer Driver's Setup Screen

408
Wrong Language Appears in LCD

Follow the instructions below to select your language.

1. Press Setup button and wait a little.

2. Press button twice and press OK button.

3. Press button 3 times and press OK button.

4. Use button to select language for LCD and press OK button.


The desired language appears on the LCD.

5. Press Stop button.

409
Installation and Download Problems

Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows)

Updating MP Drivers in Network Environment (Windows)

410
Failed to MP Drivers Installation (Windows)

• If installation does not start when you insert Setup CD-ROM:

Follow the instructions below to start the installation.

1. Make the following settings.


◦ In Windows 10, click Start > File Explorer, and then click This PC from list on left.
◦ In Windows 8.1, select Explorer icon in Taskbar on Desktop, and then select This PC from
list on left.
◦ In Windows 7, click Start, and then click Computer.

2. Double-click the CD-ROM icon in the window that appears.


If the contents of the CD-ROM appear, double-click MSETUP4.EXE.

If you cannot install the MP Drivers with the Setup CD-ROM, install them from the Canon website.

Note
• If the CD-ROM icon does not appear, try the following:

• Remove the CD-ROM from your computer and reinsert it.

• Restart your computer.

If the icon still does not appear, try a different disc and see if it appears. If it does, there is a
problem with the Setup CD-ROM. Contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

411
• If you cannot get past the Printer Connection screen:

Cannot Proceed beyond Printer Connection Screen

• Other cases:

Reinstall the MP Drivers.

If the MP Drivers were not installed correctly, uninstall the MP Drivers, restart your computer, and then
reinstall the MP Drivers.

Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers

Reinstall the MP Drivers with the Setup CD-ROM or install them from the Canon website.

Note
• If the installer was stopped due to a Windows error, Windows operation may be unstable, and you
may not be able to install the drivers. Restart your computer and then reinstall the drivers.

412
Updating MP Drivers in Network Environment (Windows)

Download the latest MP Drivers.

Download the latest MP Drivers for your model on the download page of the Canon website.

Uninstall the existing MP Drivers and follow the installation instructions to install the latest MP Drivers that
you downloaded. In the connection method selection screen, select Use the printer with Wi-Fi
connection. The printer is detected automatically in the network.

Make sure the printer was found, and install the MP Drivers following the on-screen instructions.

Note
• The network settings on the printer are not affected, so the printer can be used on the network without
redoing settings.

413
Errors and Messages

An Error Occurs

Message (Support Code) Appears

414
An Error Occurs

If an error occurs in printing, for example if the paper runs out or jams, a troubleshooting message appears
automatically. Take the appropriate action described in the message.

When an error occurs, a message appears on the computer, or an error code appears on the printer. For
some errors, a support code (error number) appears on the computer screen.

When a Support Code and a message are displayed on the computer


screen (Windows):

When a Support Code and a message are displayed on the printer


(LCD):

For details on how to resolve errors, see List of Support Code for Error.

Note
• For details on how to resolve errors without Support Codes, see Message (Support Code) Appears.

415
Message (Support Code) Appears

This section describes some of the errors and messages that may appear.

Note
• A support code (error number) is displayed on the computer for some errors. For details on errors that
have support code, see List of Support Code for Error.

If a message appears on the LCD, see below.

Message Appears on LCD

If a message appears on the computer, see below.

Error Regarding Automatic Duplex Printing Is Displayed


Error Regarding Power Cord Being Unplugged Is Displayed (Windows)
Writing Error/Output Error/Communication Error (Windows)
Other Error Messages (Windows)

Message Appears on LCD

Check the message and take an appropriate action.

• Check page size Press [OK]

The size of the loaded paper is different from that specified in the paper size setting.

Load the same size of paper as that specified in the paper size setting and press the OK button.

• Data error Press [OK]

A power failure has occurred or the power cord has been unplugged when the faxes are stored in the
printer's memory.

Important
• If a power failure occurs or you unplug the power cord, all faxes stored in the printer's memory
are deleted.
• For details on how to unplug the power cord, see Unplugging the Printer.

Press the OK button.

After pressing the OK button, the list of the faxes deleted from the printer's memory (MEMORY
CLEAR REPORT) will be printed.

For details, refer to Summary of Reports and Lists.

• Cannot connect to the server; try again

You cannot connect to the server due to some communication error.

Press the OK button to dismiss the error and try again after a while.

416
Error Regarding Automatic Duplex Printing Is Displayed

Check See Automatic Duplex Printing Problems and take the appropriate action.

Error Regarding Power Cord Being Unplugged Is Displayed


(Windows)

The printer may have been unplugged while it was on.

Check the error message that appears on the computer and click OK.

The printer starts printing.

See Unplugging the Printer for unplugging the power cord.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

Writing Error/Output Error/Communication Error (Windows)

Check1 If the ON lamp is off, make sure printer is plugged in and turn on.
The ON lamp flashes while the printer is initializing. Wait until the ON lamp stops flashing and remains lit.

Check2 Make sure printer is properly connected to computer.


If you are using a USB cable, make sure it is securely connected to both the printer and the computer. When
the USB cable is securely plugged in, check the following:

• If you are using a relay device such as a USB hub, disconnect it, connect the printer directly to the
computer, and retry the printing. If printing starts normally, there is a problem with the relay device.
Contact the vendor of the relay device.

• There could also be a problem with the USB cable. Replace the USB cable and retry the printing.

If you use the printer over a LAN, make sure the printer is correctly set up for network use.

Check3 Make sure MP Drivers are installed correctly.


Uninstall the MP Drivers following the procedure described in Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers and
reinstall them from the Setup CD-ROM or the Canon website.

417
Check4 When printer is connected to your computer with a USB cable, check device
status from your computer.
Follow the procedure below to check the device status.

1. Select Control Panel > Programs > Programs and Features.

Note
• If the User Account Control screen appears, select Continue.

2. Double-click Universal Serial Bus controllers and USB Printing Support.


If USB Printing Support Properties screen does not appear, make sure the printer is correctly connected to the computer.
Check2 Make sure printer is properly connected to computer.

3. Click General tab and check for a device problem.


If a device error is shown, see Windows Help to resolve it.

Other Error Messages (Windows)

Check If an error message appears outside printer status monitor, check the
following:
• "Could not spool successfully due to insufficient disk space"
Delete any unnecessary files to increase the amount of free space on the disk.

• "Could not spool successfully due to insufficient memory"


Close other applications to increase the available memory.
If you still cannot print, restart your computer and retry the printing.

• "Printer driver could not be found"


Uninstall the MP Drivers following the procedure described in Deleting the Unnecessary MP Drivers and
reinstall them from the Setup CD-ROM or the Canon website.

• "Could not print Application name - File name"


Try printing again once the current job is complete.

418
List of Support Code for Error

Support code appears on the LCD and your computer screen when errors occur.

A "support code" is an error number, and appears along with an error message.

When an error occurs, check the support code displayed on the LCD and on the computer screen and take
the appropriate action in response.

Support Code Appears on LCD and Computer Screen

• 1000 to 1ZZZ

1003 1200 1203 1250 1300 1303

1304 1309 1310 1401 1403 1430

1485 15A1 15A2 1682 1684 1686

1688 168A 1702 1703 1704 1705

1712 1713 1714 1715 1871 1890

• 2000 to 2ZZZ

2110 2120 2700 2801 2802 2803

2900 2901

• 3000 to 3ZZZ

3402 3403 3404 3405 3406 3407

340D 340E 3410 3411 3412 3413

3434 3435 3436 3437 3438 3439

3440 3441 3446 3447

• 4000 to 4ZZZ

4100 4103 495A

• 5000 to 5ZZZ

5011 5012 5040 5050 5100 5200

5205 5206 5B02 5B03 5B04 5B05

5B12 5B13 5B14 5B15

419
• 6000 to 6ZZZ

6000 6500 6800 6801 6900 6901

6902 6910 6911 6930 6931 6932

6933 6936 6937 6938 6939 693A

6940 6941 6942 6943 6944 6945

6946 6D01

• 7000 to 7ZZZ

7500 7600 7700 7800

• 9000 to 9ZZZ

9500

For paper jam support codes, see also List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams).

420
List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams)

If paper jams, remove it following the appropriate procedure as shown below.

• If you can see the jammed paper at the paper output slot:
1300

• If you cannot see the jammed paper at the paper output slot:

◦ If the paper fed from the cassette is jammed:

1303

◦ If the paper is jammed when performing automatic duplex printing:

1304
• If the document is jammed in the ADF:

2801

• If the paper tears and you cannot remove it from the paper output slot or if the paper is jammed inside
the printer:

Paper Is Jammed inside Printer


• Cases other than above:

Other Cases

421
1300

Cause
Paper is jammed in the paper output slot.

What to Do
If you can see the jammed paper at the paper output slot, remove the paper following the procedure
below.

Important
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.

Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not
unplug when turning off the printer.

If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

1. Slowly pull out paper.


Hold the paper with both hands, and pull it out slowly so as not to tear it.

Note
• If you cannot pull out the paper, turn the printer back on without pulling forcibly. The paper may
be ejected automatically.
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press
the Stop button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.
• If the paper tears and you cannot remove the jammed paper from the paper output slot, remove
the paper from inside the printer.

Paper Is Jammed inside Printer


• If you cannot pull the paper out from the paper output slot or from inside the printer, try to pull
the paper out from the rear side of the printer.

Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side

2. Reload paper and press printer's OK button.

422
The printer resumes printing. Reprint the page you were printing if it was not printed properly due to
the paper jam.
If you turned off the printer in step 1, the print data that was sent to the printer is erased. Redo the
printing.

Note
• When reloading the paper, make sure you are using suitable paper and loading it correctly.
• We recommend using paper sizes other than A5 to print documents with photos or graphics. A5
paper may curl and jam as it leaves the printer.

If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a
repair.

423
1303

Cause
Paper is jammed in the transport unit.

What to Do

1. Remove jammed paper.


• If the paper is jammed at the paper output slot:
1300

• If the paper is jammed inside the printer:


Paper Is Jammed inside Printer

• If none of the above is applied, see Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side to open the rear
cover and to remove the paper.

2. Load paper in cassette properly.


When you push the cassette back, grab the tabs at both sides of the front cover and push the cassette
back until the arrow ( ) on the front cover is aligned with edge of the printer.

Loading Paper

3. Perform printing or copying again.

424
1304

Cause
Paper is jammed when performing automatic duplex printing.

What to Do

1. Remove jammed paper.


• If the paper is jammed at the paper output slot:
1300

• If the paper is jammed inside the printer:


Paper Is Jammed inside Printer

• If none of the above is applied, see Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side to open the rear
cover and to remove the paper.

2. Load paper in cassette properly.


When you push the cassette back, grab the tabs at both sides of the front cover and push the cassette
back until the arrow ( ) on the front cover is aligned with edge of the printer.

Loading Paper

3. Perform printing or copying again.

425
Paper Is Jammed inside Printer

If the jammed paper tears and you cannot remove the paper either from the paper output slot or from the
transport unit, or if the jammed paper remains inside the printer, remove the paper following the procedure
below.

Important
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.

Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not unplug
when turning off the printer.

If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

Note
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press the
Stop button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.

1. Turn off printer and unplug it.

2. Open paper output cover.


Remove the paper in the cassette if any.

Important
• Do not touch clear film (A).

If you soil or scratch this part by touching it with paper or your hand, it could damage the printer.

3. Check if jammed paper is under FINE cartridge holder.

426
If the jammed paper is under the FINE cartridge holder, move the FINE cartridge holder to the far right or
left, whichever makes it easier to remove the paper.
When moving the FINE cartridge holder, hold the top of the FINE cartridge holder and slide it slowly to
the far right or left.

4. Hold jammed paper firmly in both hands.

If the paper is rolled up, pull out it.

5. Slowly pull out paper, so as not to tear it.

427
6. Make sure all jammed paper is removed.
If the paper tears when you pull out it, a bit of paper may remain in the printer. Check the following and
remove any remaining paper.

• Any paper left under the FINE cartridge holder?


• Any small bits of paper left in the printer?
• Any paper left in the left and right empty spaces (B) in the printer?

7. Close paper output cover.

8. Plug printer back in and turn printer back on.


All jobs in the print queue are canceled. Redo the printing.

Note
• When reloading the paper, make sure you are using suitable paper and loading it correctly. If a
paper jam message appears on the LCD of the printer or on your computer screen when you
resume printing after removing all the jammed paper, there may be some paper still inside the
printer. Check the printer again for any remaining bits of paper.

If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a
repair.

428
Removing Jammed Paper from Rear Side

Important
• The printer cannot be turned off while it is sending or receiving a fax, or when the received fax or the
unsent fax is stored in the printer's memory.

Turn off the printer after making sure it has completed sending or receiving all the faxes. Do not unplug
when turning off the printer.

If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

Note
• If paper becomes jammed during printing and you need to turn off the printer to remove it, press Stop
button to stop the printing before you turn off the printer.

1. Turn off printer and unplug it.

2. Retract output tray extension and paper output support, close front cover.

3. Open document cover.


Close the document tray if it is open.

4. Stand printer with right side of front facing down.

Important
• Stand the printer on a wide and flat surface such as a desk.

• When you stand the printer, hold it securely and be careful not to hit it on a hard object.

5. Open transport unit cover.


When you open the transport unit cover, support the printer with your hand so that it does not fall down.

429
6. Slowly pull out paper.
When you pull the jammed paper, support the printer with your hand so that it does not fall down.

Note
• If the paper is rolled up and it is difficult to remove, grasp the edges of the paper, then remove the
jammed paper.

7. Close transport unit cover.

430
Note
• After you close the transport unit cover, take back the printer in original position at once.

8. Plug printer back in and turn printer back on.


If the measures above do not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a
repair.

431
1003

Cause
Printer is out of paper, or paper does not feed.

What to Do
Close the paper output tray, pull the cassette out, and then load the paper.

Loading Paper

When you load the paper, insert the paper stack until the leading edge touches the far end of the
cassette.

After loading the paper, push the cassette so that the mark on the cassette aligns with the front panel
as illustrated below.

Open the paper output tray, then press the printer's OK button.

Note
• To cancel printing, press the printer's Stop button.

432
1200

Cause
Paper output cover is open.

What to Do
Close the paper output cover and wait for a while.

Do not close it while you are replacing a FINE cartridge.

433
1203

Cause
Paper output cover is opened during printing.

What to Do
If paper remains inside the printer, slowly pull out the paper with both hands and close the paper output
cover.

Press the printer's OK button to resolve the error.

The printer ejects one blank sheet of paper and resumes printing from the next paper.
The printer will not reprint the page that was printed when the paper output cover is opened. Retry
printing.

Important
• Do not open or close the cover during printing, as this can damage the printer.

434
1250

Cause
Paper output tray is closed.

What to Do
Open the paper output tray to resume printing.

435
1401

Cause
FINE cartridge is not installed.

What to Do
Install the FINE cartridge.

If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Contact your nearest Canon service
center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

436
1430

Cause
FINE cartridge cannot be recognized.

What to Do
Remove the FINE cartridge and reinstall it.

If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Replace the FINE cartridge with a new
one.

If this still does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

437
1485

Cause
Appropriate ink cartridge is not installed.

What to Do
Printing cannot be executed because the ink cartridge is not compatible with this printer.

Install the appropriate ink cartridge.

If you want to cancel printing, press the printer's Stop button.

438
1682

Cause
FINE cartridge cannot be recognized.

What to Do
Replace the FINE cartridge.

If the error is not resolved, the FINE cartridge may be damaged. Contact your nearest Canon service
center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

439
1686

Cause
The ink may have run out.

What to Do
The function for detecting the remaining ink level will be disabled since the ink level cannot be correctly
detected.

If you want to continue printing without this function, press the printer's Stop button for at least 5 seconds.

Canon recommends to use new genuine Canon cartridges in order to obtain optimum qualities.
Please be advised that Canon shall not be liable for any malfunction or trouble caused by continuation of
printing under the ink out condition.

440
1688

Cause
The ink has run out.

What to Do
Replace the ink cartridge and close the paper output cover.

If printing is in progress and you want to continue printing, press the printer's Stop button for at least 5
seconds with the ink cartridge installed. Then printing can continue under the ink out condition.

The function for detecting the remaining ink level will be disabled.
Replace the empty ink cartridge immediately after the printing. The resulting print quality is not
satisfactory, if printing is continued under the ink out condition.

441
168A

Cause
FINE cartridge is not installed properly, or FINE cartridge not compatible with this printer is installed.

What to Do
Retract the output tray extension and the paper output support, open the paper output cover, and then
remove the FINE cartridges.

Make sure the FINE cartridge compatible with the printer is installed.

Then install the FINE cartridges again.


Replacing a FINE Cartridge

Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.

After installing, close the paper output cover.

442
1890

Cause
Protective material or tape may still be attached to FINE cartridge holder.

What to Do
Open the paper output cover, then confirm that the protective material or the tape does not remain
attached to the FINE cartridge holder.

If you find the protective material or the tape remains attached, remove it, then close the paper output
cover.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

443
2110

Cause
Paper settings for printing or copying do not match cassette paper information set on printer.

Note
• See below for the correct correspondence between paper settings made on the printer driver or on
the LCD.

Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size) (Windows)

• For copying, make the copy paper settings to match cassette paper information set on the printer.
• See below for details on cassette paper information set on the printer.

Paper Settings

If the print or copy paper settings do not match cassette paper information set on the printer, as shown
below, a message appears on the LCD.

• Print settings specified on the printer driver:

Paper size: A5

Media type: Plain paper

• Cassette paper information set on the printer:

Paper size: A4

Media type: Plain paper

What to Do
Press the printer's OK button to display the screen below.

Select the appropriate action.

Note
• Depending on settings, some of the options below may not appear.

Use cass. settings


Select this option to print or copy onto the paper in the cassette without changing the paper settings.

For example, if the print or copy paper setting is A5, and cassette paper information is set to A4, the
A5 size setting is used to print or copy onto the paper in the cassette.

Replace the paper


Select this option to print after changing the paper in the cassette.

444
For example, if the print or copy paper setting is A5, and cassette paper information is set to A4,
change the paper in the cassette to A5 paper and proceed with printing or copying.

Once you have inserted the cassette after changing the paper, the screen for setting cassette paper
information appears. Set paper information for the paper in the cassette.

Note
• If you do not know what paper information to set, press the Back button. The previous screen
appears, showing the paper size and media type. Check the paper settings and set them as cassette
paper information.
• See below for the correct correspondence between paper settings made on the printer driver or on
the LCD.

Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Media Type) (Windows)
Paper Settings on the Printer Driver and the Printer (Paper Size) (Windows)

Cancel
Cancels printing.

Select this option when you want to change the print or copy paper settings. Change the paper
settings and retry printing.

Note
• To suppress the misprint prevention message, change the setting as described below. When you
suppress the message, the printer uses the paper settings for printing or copying onto the paper in
the cassette regardless of whether or not the paper matches these settings.
• To change the message view setting when printing or copying using the operation panel of the
printer:

Feed settings
• To change the message view setting when printing using the printer driver:

Changing the Printer Operation Mode (Windows)


Changing the Printer Operation Mode (macOS)

445
2900

Cause
Scanning print head alignment sheet failed.

What to Do
Press the printer's OK button and check the following.

• Make sure the print head alignment sheet is set in the correct position and orientation on the platen.
• Make sure the platen and the print head alignment sheet are not dirty.
• Make sure the loaded paper is correct.
For print head alignment, load A4 or Letter-sized plain paper.

• Make sure the print head nozzle is not clogged.

Check the print head condition by printing the nozzle check pattern.

After checking the above, start over auto print head alignment from the beginning.

If the error is still not resolved, try manual print head alignment.

446
2901

Cause
Print head alignment pattern has been printed and printer is waiting to scan sheet.

What to Do
Scan the printed alignment pattern.

1. Load print head alignment sheet on platen.

Place the printed side down and align the mark in the upper left corner of the sheet with the
alignment mark .

2. Slowly close the document cover and press printer's Black or Color button.
The printer starts scanning the print head alignment sheet, and automatically adjusts the print head
position.

447
4103

Cause
Cannot perform printing with current print settings.

What to Do
Press the printer's Stop button to cancel printing.

Then change the print settings and retry printing.

448
5011

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
Turn off printer and unplug it.

Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

449
5012

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
Turn off printer and unplug it.

Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

450
5100

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
Cancel printing and turn off the printer.

Check the following:

• Make sure FINE cartridge holder motion is not impeded by stabilizer, jammed paper, etc.
Remove any impediment.

• Make sure the FINE cartridges are properly installed.

Push up the FINE cartridge until it clicks into place.

Turn the printer back on.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• When clearing an impediment to FINE cartridge holder motion, be careful not to touch clear film (A).

If you soil or scratch this part by touching it with paper or your hand, it could damage the printer.

• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

451
5200

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
Turn off printer and unplug it.

Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

452
5B02

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
Contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

Note
• In the case of warnings or errors caused by remaining ink levels, the printer cannot print or scan.

453
6000

Cause
Printer error has occurred.

What to Do
If the paper is jammed, remove it depending on the jammed location and cause.

List of Support Code for Error (Paper Jams)

Turn off printer and unplug it.


Plug in the printer again and turn it back on.

If this does not solve the problem, contact your nearest Canon service center to request a repair.

Important
• If you unplug the power cord, all the faxes stored in the printer's memory are deleted.

454

You might also like